1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.83"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
441 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
447 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
450 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
459 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
490 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
495 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496 .cindex "training courses"
497 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
502 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503 .cindex "bug reports"
504 .cindex "reporting bugs"
505 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
512 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
514 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
517 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
521 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
523 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
527 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
535 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
539 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
541 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
551 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
556 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
565 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
569 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
574 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
579 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
583 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
585 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
586 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
593 .cindex "domainless addresses"
594 .cindex "address" "without domain"
595 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
601 .cindex "transport" "external"
602 .cindex "external transports"
603 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
610 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
615 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619 a number of common scanners are provided.
623 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
631 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
640 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
644 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
651 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652 .cindex "terminology definitions"
653 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656 below) by a blank line.
658 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665 rise to further bounce messages.
667 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
672 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
677 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
681 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
682 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
683 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
690 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
692 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
698 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
699 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
700 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
704 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
711 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
712 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
715 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
716 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
721 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
727 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
742 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743 .cindex "incorporated code"
744 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
747 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
750 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
757 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762 following statements:
765 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
767 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
771 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775 restrictions applied to it).
778 .cindex "SPA authentication"
779 .cindex "Samba project"
780 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
787 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792 conditions expressed therein.
795 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
797 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
802 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
805 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
810 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813 details, please contact
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
823 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
826 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
829 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
840 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
843 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
849 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
854 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860 software without specific, written prior permission.
862 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
872 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
880 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
892 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
896 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897 .cindex "design philosophy"
898 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
906 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
908 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
915 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
926 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
929 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
934 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
940 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
944 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946 runs at the start of every delivery process.
951 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
952 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
953 .cindex "Sieve filter"
954 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959 of filtering are available:
962 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
965 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
969 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
973 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975 .cindex "format" "of message id"
976 .cindex "id of message"
981 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988 not always case-sensitive.
990 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
999 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002 way of representing the date and time of day).
1004 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005 received the message.
1007 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1009 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1015 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017 (1/100) of a second.
1021 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1028 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029 .cindex "receiving mail"
1030 .cindex "message" "reception"
1031 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034 there are several possibilities:
1037 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1041 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1048 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1054 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1061 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073 users to change sender addresses.
1075 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1083 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088 message is received.
1094 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1103 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112 affect file system performance.
1114 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1120 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1135 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136 .cindex "message" "life of"
1137 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1138 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1145 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1152 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1158 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1159 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1170 .cindex "journal file"
1171 .cindex "file" "journal"
1172 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1181 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185 deliveries caused by crashes.
1189 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1199 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207 the driver's features in general.
1209 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1215 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1222 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1229 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1234 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242 configured to fail the address.
1244 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1251 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256 the address is bounced.
1260 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1262 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1269 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1281 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282 .cindex "router" "running details"
1283 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1285 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1292 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294 original address ceases,
1295 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1302 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1308 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1314 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1320 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1324 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1329 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1333 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1339 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343 facility for this purpose.
1346 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347 .cindex "case of local parts"
1348 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354 routed addresses are shown.
1358 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1410 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1413 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417 remaining preconditions.
1419 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423 could lead to confusion.
1425 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426 set of addresses that it defines.
1428 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429 specified files is tested.
1431 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1438 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1448 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1453 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1459 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1462 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1470 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474 processed entirely independently of each other.
1476 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1486 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493 addresses to the same domain.
1495 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1504 .cindex "queue runner"
1505 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1515 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1522 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525 messages to other addresses.
1527 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1532 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1540 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543 .cindex "queue runner"
1544 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551 passed its retry time.
1552 You can run several queue runners at once.
1554 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1563 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1574 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1578 .cindex "hints database"
1579 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1587 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1599 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1604 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1615 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1631 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1634 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1640 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1643 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1650 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651 following subdirectories are created:
1654 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1663 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665 that may be useful to some sites.
1668 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1675 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679 overridden if necessary.
1682 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683 .cindex "PCRE library"
1684 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692 If your operating system has no
1693 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1697 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1705 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1714 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721 Berkeley DB library.
1723 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1728 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1731 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735 file name is used unmodified.
1737 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1742 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1746 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1748 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1753 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756 operates on a single file.
1760 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1768 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1771 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1778 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780 in one of these lines:
1785 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1791 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1794 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1799 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1812 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1819 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1827 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830 facilities, you need to set
1832 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1834 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1838 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1846 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1855 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1858 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1866 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1874 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1878 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1890 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1894 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1897 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1899 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1903 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1906 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1910 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1912 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1917 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1919 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920 library and include files. For example:
1924 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1927 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1932 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1935 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1942 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1944 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1958 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1962 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1965 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1967 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1976 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1984 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1989 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1990 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1991 support has not been tested for some time.
1995 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1996 .cindex "lookup modules"
1997 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1998 .cindex ".so building"
1999 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2000 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2002 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2003 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2005 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2007 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2008 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2009 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2010 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2011 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2012 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2014 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2015 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2016 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2025 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2026 .cindex "build directory"
2027 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2028 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2029 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2030 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2031 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2032 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2033 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2035 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
2036 building process fails if it is set.
2038 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2039 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2040 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2041 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2042 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2043 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2044 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2045 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2047 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2048 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2049 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2053 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2054 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2055 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2056 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2057 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2058 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2059 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2063 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2064 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2065 given in addition to the short output.
2069 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2070 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2071 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2072 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2073 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2074 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2075 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2078 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2079 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2081 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2082 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2083 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2084 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2086 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2087 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2088 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2089 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2090 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2091 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2092 and are often not needed.
2094 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2095 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2096 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2097 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2098 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2099 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2100 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2101 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2102 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2105 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2106 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2107 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2108 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2112 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2113 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2114 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2115 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2116 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2117 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2118 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2119 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2120 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2121 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2122 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2123 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2124 containing the lines
2129 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2130 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2132 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2133 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2134 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2137 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2138 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2139 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2140 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2141 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2142 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2143 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2144 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2145 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2146 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2152 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2153 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2154 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2155 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2156 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2157 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2158 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2159 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2162 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2163 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2164 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2165 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2166 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2167 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2168 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2169 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2170 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2171 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2172 syntax. For instance:
2175 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2177 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2178 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2179 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2182 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2183 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2184 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2188 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2189 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2191 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2192 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2193 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2194 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2195 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2196 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2199 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2200 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2202 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2203 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2206 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2207 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2209 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2210 definition of all three of these variables into your
2211 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2214 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2215 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2216 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2217 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2219 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2220 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2221 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2222 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2223 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2226 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2227 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2228 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2229 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2230 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2233 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2235 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2236 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2237 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2238 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2239 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2240 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2244 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2245 .cindex "building Eximon"
2246 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2247 where the files that are involved are
2249 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2250 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2251 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2252 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2253 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2254 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2256 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2257 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2258 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2259 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2260 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2261 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2262 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2266 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2267 .cindex "installing Exim"
2268 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2269 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2270 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2271 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2272 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2273 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2274 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2275 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2276 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2277 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2278 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2279 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2281 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2282 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2283 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2284 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2285 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2286 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2287 alternative files, no default is installed.
2289 .cindex "system aliases file"
2290 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2291 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2292 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2293 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2294 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2295 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2296 and outputs a comment to the user.
2298 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2299 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2300 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2301 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2302 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2304 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2305 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2306 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2307 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2308 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2311 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2312 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2315 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2317 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2318 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2319 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2320 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2321 but this usage is deprecated.
2323 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2324 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2325 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2326 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2327 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2328 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2330 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2331 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2332 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2333 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2334 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2335 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2336 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2338 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2339 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2340 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2343 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2345 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2346 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2347 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2348 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2351 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2353 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2354 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2357 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2358 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2360 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2364 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2366 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2368 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2369 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2370 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2372 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2377 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2378 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2379 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2380 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2381 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2384 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2385 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2386 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2390 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2391 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2392 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2393 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2394 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2400 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2401 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2402 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2403 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2404 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2408 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2409 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2410 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2411 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2412 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2415 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2417 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2419 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2421 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2422 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2423 user agent. For example:
2425 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2426 From: user@your.domain.example
2427 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2428 Subject: Testing Exim
2430 This is a test message.
2433 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2434 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2435 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2437 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2438 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2439 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2440 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2441 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2442 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2444 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2446 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2447 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2448 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2449 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2450 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2452 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2453 .cindex "lock files"
2454 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2455 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2456 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2457 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2458 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2459 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2460 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2461 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2462 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2463 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2464 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2465 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2467 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2468 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2469 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2470 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2471 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2474 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2475 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2476 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2477 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2481 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2482 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2483 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2484 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2485 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2486 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2487 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2488 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2489 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2490 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2491 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2492 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2493 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2495 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2496 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2497 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2498 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2499 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2500 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2503 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2504 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2505 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2506 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2508 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2509 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2510 favourite user agent.
2512 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2513 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2514 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2515 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2516 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2517 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2521 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2522 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2523 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2524 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2525 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2526 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2527 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2528 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2534 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2535 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2536 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2538 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2540 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2541 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2542 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2543 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2544 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2546 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2548 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2550 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2551 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2552 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2557 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2558 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2560 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2561 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2562 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2563 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2564 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2565 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2566 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2567 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2568 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2571 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2573 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2574 were present before any other options.
2575 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2577 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2578 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2579 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2582 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2583 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2584 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2588 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2589 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2590 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2593 .cindex "queue runner"
2594 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2595 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2596 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2598 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2599 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2600 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2601 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2602 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2603 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2604 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2605 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2608 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2609 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2610 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2611 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2612 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2613 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2616 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2617 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2618 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2619 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2620 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2621 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2623 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2624 .cindex "envelope sender"
2625 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2626 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2627 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2628 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2629 users to set envelope senders.
2631 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2632 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2633 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2634 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2635 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2637 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2638 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2639 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2640 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2641 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2642 that are available to trusted users.
2644 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2645 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2646 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2647 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2648 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2650 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2651 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2652 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2653 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2655 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2656 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2657 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2658 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2660 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2661 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2666 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2667 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2668 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2674 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2675 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2676 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2677 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2678 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2679 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2680 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2681 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2683 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2684 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2685 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2686 . creates a man page for the options.
2687 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2690 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2697 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2698 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2699 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2700 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2703 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2704 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2705 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2708 .vitem &%--version%&
2709 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2710 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2717 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2720 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2722 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2723 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2724 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2725 clean; it ignores this option.
2730 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2731 .cindex "queue runner"
2732 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2733 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2734 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2736 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2737 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2738 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2739 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2741 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2742 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2743 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2744 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2746 When a listening daemon
2747 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2748 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2749 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2750 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2751 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2752 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2755 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2756 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2757 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2761 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2762 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2763 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2764 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2765 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2766 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2767 because these are reread each time they are used.
2771 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2772 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2776 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2777 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2778 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2779 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2780 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2781 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2783 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2784 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2785 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2786 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2787 test data. A line history is supported.
2789 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2790 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2791 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2792 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2793 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2794 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2795 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2797 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2798 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2799 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2800 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2802 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2804 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2805 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2806 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2807 of a file. For example:
2809 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2811 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2812 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2813 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2814 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2815 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2816 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2817 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2820 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2822 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2823 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2824 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2825 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2826 system filters are recognized.
2828 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2830 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2831 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2832 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2833 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2834 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2835 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2836 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2837 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2840 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2841 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2842 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2844 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2846 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2847 variables that are used by the user filter.
2849 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2854 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2855 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2856 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2859 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2860 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2861 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2862 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2864 When testing a filter file,
2865 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2866 .cindex "envelope sender"
2867 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2868 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2869 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2870 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2871 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2874 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2876 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2877 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2878 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2881 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2883 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2884 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2885 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2886 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2887 actually being delivered.
2889 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2891 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2892 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2895 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2897 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2898 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2901 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2903 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2904 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2905 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2906 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2907 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2908 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2909 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2910 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2911 after a full stop. For example:
2913 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2914 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2916 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2917 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2918 conversion to the canonical form is
2919 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2921 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2922 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2923 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2924 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2925 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2929 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2930 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2931 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2934 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2935 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2936 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2938 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2939 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2940 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2941 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2942 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2943 session were authenticated.
2945 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2946 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2947 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2949 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2950 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2951 specialized SMTP test program such as
2952 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2954 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2956 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2957 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2958 updating the callout cache database.
2962 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2963 .cindex "building alias file"
2964 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2965 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2966 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2967 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2968 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2971 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2972 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2973 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2974 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2975 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2976 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2979 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2981 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2982 .cindex "querying exim information"
2983 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2984 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2985 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2986 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2987 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2990 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2991 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2992 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2993 recognised DSCP names.
2995 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2996 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2997 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2998 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2999 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3000 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3001 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3002 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3003 way to guarantee a correct response.
3007 .cindex "local message reception"
3008 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3009 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3010 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3011 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3012 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3013 if no other conflicting option is present.
3015 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3016 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3017 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3018 suppressing this for special cases.
3020 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3021 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3023 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3024 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3025 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3028 .cindex "message" "format"
3029 .cindex "format" "message"
3030 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3031 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3032 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3033 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3034 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3036 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3037 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3039 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3040 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3041 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3042 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3043 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3045 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3046 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3047 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3048 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3049 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3051 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3052 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3053 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3054 .cindex "malware scan test"
3055 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3056 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3057 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3058 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3059 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3060 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3062 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3063 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3064 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3065 This option requires admin privileges.
3067 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3068 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3069 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3073 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3074 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3075 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3076 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3077 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3078 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3079 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3081 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3082 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3083 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3084 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3085 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3087 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3088 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3089 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3090 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3095 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3096 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3097 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3098 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3099 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3100 arguments, for example:
3102 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3104 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3105 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3106 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3107 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3108 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3109 users, the output is as in this example:
3111 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3113 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3114 configuration file is output.
3115 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3116 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3118 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3119 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3120 name will not be output.
3122 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3123 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3124 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3125 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3126 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3127 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3128 written directly into the spool directory.
3130 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3132 exim -bP +local_domains
3134 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3135 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3137 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3138 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3139 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3140 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3141 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3142 that driver are output. For example:
3144 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3146 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3147 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3148 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3149 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3150 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3153 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3154 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3155 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3156 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3157 The output format is one item per line.
3161 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3162 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3163 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3164 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3165 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3166 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3167 to allow any user to see the queue.
3169 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3171 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3172 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3175 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3176 .cindex "size" "of message"
3177 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3178 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3179 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3180 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3181 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3182 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3183 before the sender address.
3185 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3186 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3187 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3189 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3190 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3191 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3192 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3193 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3199 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3200 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3201 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3207 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3208 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3209 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3210 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3215 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3216 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3217 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3218 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3222 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3226 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3231 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3232 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3233 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3234 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3239 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3240 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3241 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3242 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3243 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3245 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3246 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3248 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3249 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3250 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3251 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3252 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3253 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3254 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3255 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3256 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3258 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3259 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3264 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3265 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3266 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3267 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3268 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3269 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3270 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3274 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3275 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3276 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3277 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3278 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3279 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3280 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3281 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3282 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3284 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3285 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3286 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3288 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3289 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3290 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3291 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3293 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3294 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3295 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3297 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3298 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3299 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3300 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3301 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3303 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3304 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3308 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3309 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3310 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3311 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3312 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3313 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3314 messages to the MTA.
3317 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3318 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3319 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3320 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3321 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3322 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3323 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3327 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3328 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3329 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3330 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3331 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3332 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3333 the listening daemon.
3337 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3338 .cindex "address" "testing"
3339 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3340 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3341 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3342 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3343 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3345 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3346 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3348 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3349 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3352 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3353 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3354 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3355 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3356 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3359 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3360 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3361 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3362 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3364 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3365 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3366 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3367 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3370 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3371 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3373 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3374 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3375 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3376 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3377 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3378 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3383 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3384 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3385 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3386 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3387 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3388 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3390 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3391 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3392 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3393 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3394 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3395 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3396 dynamic testing facilities.
3400 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3401 .cindex "address" "verification"
3402 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3403 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3404 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3405 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3406 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3407 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3409 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3410 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3411 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3413 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3414 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3416 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3417 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3420 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3421 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3422 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3423 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3424 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3426 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3427 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3428 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3429 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3430 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3431 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3434 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3435 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3436 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3439 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3440 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3441 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3442 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3444 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3445 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3446 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3447 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3451 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3452 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3459 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3460 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3461 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3462 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3464 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3465 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3466 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3467 each port only when the first connection is received.
3469 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3470 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3472 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3474 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3475 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3476 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3477 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3478 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3479 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3480 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3481 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3482 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3484 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3485 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3486 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3487 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3488 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3489 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3490 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3491 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3492 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3494 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3495 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3496 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3497 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3498 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3499 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3500 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3502 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3503 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3504 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3505 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3506 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3507 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3508 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3510 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3511 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3512 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3515 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3516 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3517 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3518 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3519 specified by this option.
3522 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3524 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3525 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3526 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3527 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3528 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3529 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3531 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3532 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3533 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3534 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3535 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3536 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3537 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3539 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3540 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3541 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3547 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3548 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3551 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3553 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3556 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3558 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3559 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3560 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3561 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3562 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3563 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3564 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3567 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3568 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3569 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3570 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3571 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3572 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3573 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3576 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3577 &`auth `& authenticators
3578 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3579 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3580 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3581 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3582 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3583 &`filter `& filter handling
3584 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3585 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3586 &`ident `& ident lookup
3587 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3588 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3589 &`load `& system load checks
3590 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3591 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3592 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3593 &`memory `& memory handling
3594 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3595 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3596 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3597 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3598 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3599 &`retry `& retry handling
3600 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3601 &`route `& address routing
3602 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3604 &`transport `& transports
3605 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3606 &`verify `& address verification logic
3607 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3609 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3610 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3611 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3612 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3613 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3614 turn everything off.
3616 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3617 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3618 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3619 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3620 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3623 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3624 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3625 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3626 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3627 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3630 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3631 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3634 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3635 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3637 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3639 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3640 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3641 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3642 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3645 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3646 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3647 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3648 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3652 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3653 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3654 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3655 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3656 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3657 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3658 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3659 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3662 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3663 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3664 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3665 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3666 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3668 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3670 .cindex "sender" "name"
3671 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3672 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3673 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3674 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3675 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3676 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3678 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3680 .cindex "sender" "address"
3681 .cindex "address" "sender"
3682 .cindex "trusted users"
3683 .cindex "envelope sender"
3684 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3685 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3686 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3687 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3690 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3691 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3692 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3693 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3696 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3697 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3698 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3699 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3700 examples of shell commands:
3702 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3703 exim -f "" user@domain
3705 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3706 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3709 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3710 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3711 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3712 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3715 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3716 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3717 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3718 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3719 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3720 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3724 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3725 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3727 control = suppress_local_fixups
3729 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3730 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3733 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3736 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3738 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3739 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3740 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3745 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3746 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3747 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3748 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3749 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3750 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3752 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3754 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3755 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3756 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3757 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3758 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3759 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3761 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3763 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3765 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3766 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3767 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3768 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3769 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3770 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3771 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3774 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3775 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3776 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3777 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3778 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3779 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3781 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3782 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3783 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3784 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3786 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3788 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3789 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3790 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3791 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3792 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3793 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3794 can be used only by an admin user.
3796 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3797 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3799 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3800 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3801 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3802 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3803 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3804 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3805 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3806 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3810 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3811 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3812 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3816 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3817 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3818 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3820 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3822 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3823 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3824 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3825 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3826 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3827 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3831 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3832 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3833 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3838 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3839 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3840 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3842 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3844 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3845 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3846 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3847 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3848 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3849 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3850 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3851 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3852 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3853 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3854 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3855 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3856 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3858 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3860 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3861 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3862 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3863 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3864 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3865 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3866 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3867 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3869 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3871 .cindex "freezing messages"
3872 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3873 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3874 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3875 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3876 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3877 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3880 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3882 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3883 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3884 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3885 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3886 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3887 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3888 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3889 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3892 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3894 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3895 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3896 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3897 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3898 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3900 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3902 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3903 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3904 .cindex "removing recipients"
3905 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3906 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3907 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3908 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3909 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3910 can be used only by an admin user.
3912 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3914 .cindex "removing messages"
3915 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3916 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3917 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3918 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3919 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3920 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3921 placed on the queue.
3923 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3925 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3926 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3927 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3928 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3929 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3930 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3931 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3932 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3933 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3935 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3937 .cindex "thawing messages"
3938 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3939 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3940 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3941 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3942 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3943 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3946 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3948 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3949 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3950 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3951 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3953 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3955 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3956 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3957 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3958 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3959 only by an admin user.
3961 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3963 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3964 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3965 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3966 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3967 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3969 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3971 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3972 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3973 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3974 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3978 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3979 treats it that way too.
3983 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3984 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3985 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3986 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3987 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3988 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3989 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3992 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3993 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3994 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3995 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3996 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3997 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3998 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4003 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4004 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4005 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4007 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4009 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4012 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4014 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4015 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4016 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4019 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4021 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4022 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4023 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4024 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4025 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4026 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4030 .cindex "background delivery"
4031 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4032 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4033 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4034 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4035 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4036 processes to finish.
4038 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4039 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4040 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4041 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4043 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4044 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4045 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4046 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4050 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4051 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4052 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4053 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4054 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4055 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4057 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4058 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4061 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4062 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4064 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4065 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4066 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4067 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4072 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4077 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4078 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4079 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4080 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4081 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4082 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4083 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4084 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4085 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4086 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4091 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4092 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4093 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4094 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4095 configuration file is in effect.
4097 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4098 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4099 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4100 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4101 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4102 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4103 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4104 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4105 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4110 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4111 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4112 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4115 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4117 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4118 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4119 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4120 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4124 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4125 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4126 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4127 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4128 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4132 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4133 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4134 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4135 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4136 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4140 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4141 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4146 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4147 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4152 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4153 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4154 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4155 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4156 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4157 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4160 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4161 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4163 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4165 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4166 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4167 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4168 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4169 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4170 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4172 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4173 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4175 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4177 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4178 followed by a colon and the port number:
4180 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4182 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4183 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4184 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4185 whichever one is last.
4187 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4189 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4190 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4191 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4192 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4193 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4194 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4196 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4198 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4199 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4200 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4201 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4202 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4203 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4205 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4207 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4208 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4209 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4210 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4211 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4212 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4213 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4214 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4216 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4218 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4219 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4220 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4221 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4222 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4224 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4226 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4227 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4228 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4229 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4230 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4231 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4232 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4234 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4235 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4236 is sending the bounce.
4238 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4240 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4241 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4242 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4243 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4244 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4245 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4246 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4247 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4248 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4251 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4253 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4254 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4255 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4256 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4257 uses the name it is given.
4259 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4261 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4262 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4263 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4264 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4265 used, when there is no default.
4269 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4270 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4271 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4272 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4276 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4277 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4278 whatever that means.
4280 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4282 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4283 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4284 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4285 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4286 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4287 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4288 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4290 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4292 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4293 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4294 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4295 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4296 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4298 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4300 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4301 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4302 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4303 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4304 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4305 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4309 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4311 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4313 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4314 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4315 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4316 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4317 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4318 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4319 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4320 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4324 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4325 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4326 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4327 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4332 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4333 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4334 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4335 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4338 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4340 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4342 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4344 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4345 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4346 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4347 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4348 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4352 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4353 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4354 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4355 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4356 and &%-S%& options).
4358 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4359 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4360 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4361 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4362 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4363 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4366 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4367 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4368 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4369 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4370 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4373 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4374 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4375 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4376 this to be repeated periodically.
4378 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4379 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4380 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4381 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4383 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4384 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4385 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4387 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4388 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4389 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4390 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4394 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4395 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4396 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4397 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4398 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4399 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4402 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4403 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4404 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4405 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4406 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4407 delivered down a single SMTP
4408 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4409 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4410 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4411 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4412 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4415 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4417 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4418 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4419 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4420 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4421 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4423 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4425 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4426 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4427 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4428 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4429 their retry times are tried.
4431 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4433 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4434 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4437 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4439 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4440 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4441 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4444 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4445 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4446 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4447 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4448 starting message id. For example:
4450 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4452 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4453 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4454 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4456 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4458 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4459 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4460 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4461 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4462 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4463 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4465 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4466 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4467 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4468 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4469 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4470 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4471 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4472 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4473 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4475 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4477 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4478 process every 30 minutes.
4480 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4481 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4483 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4485 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4488 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4490 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4492 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4494 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4495 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4496 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4497 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4498 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4499 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4500 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4502 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4503 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4504 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4505 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4506 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4507 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4509 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4510 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4512 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4514 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4515 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4516 applied to each queue run.
4518 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4519 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4520 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4521 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4522 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4523 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4524 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4525 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4526 address will be skipped.
4528 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4529 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4530 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4533 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4534 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4535 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4536 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4537 an arbitrary command instead.
4541 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4543 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4545 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4546 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4547 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4548 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4549 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4550 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4552 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4554 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4555 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4556 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4560 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4561 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4562 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4563 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4564 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4565 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4566 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4567 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4568 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4570 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4571 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4572 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4573 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4574 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4575 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4576 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4577 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4578 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4579 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4580 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4582 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4583 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4584 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4585 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4586 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4587 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4589 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4590 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4591 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4592 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4593 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4594 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4595 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4596 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4597 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4601 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4602 compatibility with Sendmail.
4604 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4605 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4606 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4607 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4608 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4609 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4610 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4611 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4616 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4617 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4618 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4619 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4620 set. Exim ignores this option.
4624 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4625 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4626 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4627 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4628 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4629 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4634 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4635 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4636 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4639 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4641 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4642 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4649 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4650 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4651 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4652 . creates a man page for the options.
4653 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4656 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4663 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4664 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4667 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4668 "The runtime configuration file"
4670 .cindex "run time configuration"
4671 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4672 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4673 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4674 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4675 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4676 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4677 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4678 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4681 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4682 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4683 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4684 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4685 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4686 actually alter the string.
4688 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4689 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4690 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4691 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4692 existing file in the list.
4695 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4696 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4697 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4698 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4699 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4700 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4701 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4702 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4703 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4704 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4706 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4707 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4708 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4709 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4710 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4712 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4713 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4714 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4715 compromise the Exim user account.
4717 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4718 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4719 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4720 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4721 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4722 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4727 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4728 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4729 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4730 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4731 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4732 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4733 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4734 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4735 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4736 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4737 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4739 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4740 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4741 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4742 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4743 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4744 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4745 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4746 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4747 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4750 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4751 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4752 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4753 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4754 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4756 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4757 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4758 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4759 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4760 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4761 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4763 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4764 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4765 necessarily be discarded.
4766 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4767 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4768 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4769 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4770 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4771 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4773 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4774 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4775 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4776 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4777 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4778 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4779 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4781 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4782 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4783 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4787 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4788 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4789 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4790 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4791 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4792 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4793 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4797 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4800 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4801 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4802 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4804 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4805 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4806 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4808 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4809 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4810 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4812 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4813 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4814 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4815 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4818 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4819 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4820 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4822 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4823 want to use this feature, you must set
4825 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4827 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4828 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4831 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4832 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4833 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4834 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4836 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4837 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4838 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4839 and does not introduce a comment.
4841 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4842 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4843 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4844 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4845 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4847 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4848 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4849 change settings as required.
4851 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4852 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4853 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4854 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4855 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4860 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4861 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4862 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4863 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4864 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4865 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4868 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4869 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4871 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4872 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4873 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4876 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4877 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4878 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4879 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4881 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4882 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4885 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4888 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4889 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4894 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4895 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4896 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4897 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4898 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4899 definition, and must be of the form
4901 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4903 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4904 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4905 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4906 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4907 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4909 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4910 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4911 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4913 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4914 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4915 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4916 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4917 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4918 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4919 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4922 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4923 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4925 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4926 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4927 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4928 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4929 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4930 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4933 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4934 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4935 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4940 MAC == updated value
4942 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4943 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4944 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4945 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4949 MAC == MAC and something added
4951 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4952 from a number of other files.
4954 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4955 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4956 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4957 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4958 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4963 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4964 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4965 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4966 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4968 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4969 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4971 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4973 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4975 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4976 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4977 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4980 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4981 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4982 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4983 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4984 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4985 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4986 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4988 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4989 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4990 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4994 message_size_limit = 50M
4996 message_size_limit = 100M
4999 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
5000 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5001 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5002 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5004 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5005 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5006 in this line"& will always be true.
5008 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5009 to clarify complicated nestings.
5013 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5014 .cindex "common option syntax"
5015 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5016 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5017 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5018 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5019 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5020 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5021 space) and then the value. For example:
5023 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5025 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5026 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5027 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5028 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5029 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5030 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5031 word &"hide"&. For example:
5033 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5035 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5037 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5039 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5040 all instances of the same driver.
5042 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5043 that are found in option settings.
5046 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5047 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5048 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5049 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5050 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5051 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5052 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5053 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5054 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5055 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5056 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5057 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5062 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5067 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5072 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5073 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5074 .cindex "format" "integer"
5075 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5076 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5077 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5078 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5081 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5082 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5083 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5084 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5085 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5089 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5090 .cindex "integer format"
5091 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5092 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5093 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5094 Such options are always output in octal.
5097 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5098 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5099 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5100 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5101 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5105 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5106 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5107 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5108 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5109 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5119 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5120 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5121 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5125 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5126 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5127 .cindex "format" "string"
5128 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5129 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5130 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5131 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5132 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5133 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5134 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5135 therefore equivalent:
5137 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5138 trusted_users = uucp:\
5139 # This comment line is ignored
5142 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5143 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5144 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5145 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5146 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5149 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5150 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5151 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5153 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5154 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5158 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5159 character, that character replaces the pair.
5161 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5162 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5163 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5164 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5165 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5166 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5169 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5170 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5171 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5172 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5173 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5174 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5175 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5176 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5177 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5178 within a quoted configuration string.
5181 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5182 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5183 .cindex "format" "user name"
5184 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5185 .cindex "format" "group name"
5186 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5187 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5188 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5189 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5192 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5193 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5194 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5195 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5196 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5197 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5198 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5199 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5200 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5201 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5202 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5204 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5205 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5206 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5207 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5208 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5209 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5212 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5214 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5216 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5217 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5218 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5219 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5221 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
5222 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5223 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5224 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5225 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5226 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5227 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5228 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5230 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5232 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5233 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5234 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5236 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5237 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5238 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5239 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5240 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5241 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5242 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5243 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5244 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5246 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5248 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5249 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5250 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5251 the value in quotes. For example:
5253 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5255 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5256 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5257 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5258 enclosing an empty list item.
5262 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5263 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5264 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5265 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5267 senders = user@domain :
5269 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5270 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5271 items, the second of which is empty:
5273 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5275 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5276 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5277 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5278 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5282 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5283 is at the end of the list.
5288 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5289 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5290 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5291 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5292 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5293 a sequence of lines like this:
5295 <&'instance name'&>:
5300 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5301 followed by three options settings:
5306 transport = local_delivery
5308 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5309 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5310 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5311 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5312 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5313 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5315 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5316 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5318 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5319 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5320 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5321 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5322 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5325 .cindex "generic options"
5326 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5327 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5328 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5329 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5330 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5331 .cindex "private options"
5332 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5333 they all have default values.
5335 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5336 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5337 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5339 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5340 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5341 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5342 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5343 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5344 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5345 configuration lines:
5350 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5351 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5352 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5353 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5359 command_timeout = 10s
5361 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5362 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5365 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5366 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5367 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5375 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5376 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5378 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5379 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5380 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5381 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5382 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5383 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5384 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5385 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5386 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5387 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5388 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5392 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5393 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5394 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5397 # primary_hostname =
5399 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5400 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5401 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5402 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5404 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5406 domainlist local_domains = @
5407 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5408 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5410 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5411 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5412 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5413 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5415 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5416 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5419 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5420 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5421 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5422 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5423 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5424 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5426 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5427 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5428 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5429 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5430 domain is permitted.
5432 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5433 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5434 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5435 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5436 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5437 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5439 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5440 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5441 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5443 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5445 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5446 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5448 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5449 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5450 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5451 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5452 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5453 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5454 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5455 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5456 contents of a message to be checked.
5458 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5460 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5461 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5463 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5464 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5465 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5466 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5468 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5470 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5471 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5472 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5474 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5475 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5476 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5477 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5478 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5479 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5480 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5482 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5484 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5485 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5487 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5488 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5489 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5490 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5491 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5492 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5493 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5494 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5495 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5496 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5497 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5498 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5499 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5500 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5501 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5502 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5504 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5507 # qualify_recipient =
5509 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5510 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5511 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5512 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5513 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5514 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5516 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5517 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5518 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5519 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5521 # allow_domain_literals
5523 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5524 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5525 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5526 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5527 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5528 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5530 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5534 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5535 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5536 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5537 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5538 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5539 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5540 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5541 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5543 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5544 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5549 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5550 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5551 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5552 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5553 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5554 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5557 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5558 1413 (hence their names):
5561 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5563 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5564 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5565 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5566 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5567 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5568 information, you can change this.
5570 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negociated by clients
5571 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5576 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5577 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5578 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5579 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5581 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5582 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5584 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5585 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5587 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5589 # percent_hack_domains =
5591 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5592 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5593 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5595 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5596 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5597 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5598 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5599 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5600 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5601 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5602 always bounce messages.
5604 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5605 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5607 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5608 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5609 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5610 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5611 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5615 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5616 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5617 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5618 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5619 It starts with the line
5623 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5624 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5625 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5627 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5628 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5629 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5630 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5631 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5632 result of the ACL processing.
5636 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5641 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5642 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5643 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5644 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5645 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5646 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5648 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5649 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5650 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5653 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5654 domains = +local_domains
5655 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5657 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5658 domains = !+local_domains
5659 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5661 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5662 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5663 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5664 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5665 in Internet mail addresses.
5667 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5668 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5669 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5670 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5671 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5672 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5673 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5674 policy of being as safe as possible.
5676 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5677 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5678 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5679 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5680 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5681 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5683 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5684 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5685 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5686 have to modify this rule.
5688 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5689 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5690 common convention of local parts constructed as
5691 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5692 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5693 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5694 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5695 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5696 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5698 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5699 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5700 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5701 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5702 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5703 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5704 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5706 accept local_parts = postmaster
5707 domains = +local_domains
5709 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5710 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5711 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5712 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5713 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5715 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5716 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5717 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5719 require verify = sender
5721 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5722 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5723 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5724 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5725 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5726 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5727 discusses the details of address verification.
5729 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5730 control = submission
5732 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5733 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5734 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5735 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5736 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5737 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5738 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5739 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5740 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5742 accept authenticated = *
5743 control = submission
5745 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5746 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5747 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5748 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5749 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5750 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5752 require message = relay not permitted
5753 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5755 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5756 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5758 require verify = recipient
5760 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5761 fails, the address is rejected.
5763 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5764 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5766 # dnslists = black.list.example
5768 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5769 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5770 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5771 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5773 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5774 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5775 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5778 # require verify = csa
5780 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5781 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5786 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5787 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5791 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5792 of this ACL are commented out:
5795 # message = This message contains a virus \
5798 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5799 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5800 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5801 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5803 # warn spam = nobody
5804 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5805 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5806 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5807 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5809 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5810 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5811 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5812 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5813 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5814 whatever the spam score.
5818 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5821 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5822 .cindex "default" "routers"
5823 .cindex "routers" "default"
5824 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5829 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5830 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5831 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5832 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5833 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5836 # driver = ipliteral
5837 # domains = !+local_domains
5838 # transport = remote_smtp
5840 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5841 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5842 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5843 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5844 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5848 domains = ! +local_domains
5849 transport = remote_smtp
5850 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5853 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5854 domains. This is specified by the line
5856 domains = ! +local_domains
5858 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5859 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5860 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5861 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5862 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5863 passed on to the following routers.
5865 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5866 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5867 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5868 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5869 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5871 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5872 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5873 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5874 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5875 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5876 the address fails and is bounced.
5878 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5879 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5880 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5881 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5882 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5883 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5884 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5891 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5893 file_transport = address_file
5894 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5896 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5897 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5898 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5899 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5900 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5903 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5904 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5905 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5906 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5911 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5912 # local_part_suffix_optional
5913 file = $home/.forward
5918 file_transport = address_file
5919 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5920 reply_transport = address_reply
5922 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5923 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5924 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5925 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5926 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5929 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5930 # local_part_suffix_optional
5932 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5933 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5934 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5935 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5936 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5937 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5938 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5940 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5941 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5942 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5943 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5945 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5946 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5947 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5948 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5949 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5950 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5951 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5953 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5954 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5955 There are two reasons for doing this:
5958 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5959 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5962 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5963 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5964 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5965 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5969 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5970 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5971 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5972 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5974 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5975 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5976 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5978 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5980 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5986 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5987 # local_part_suffix_optional
5988 transport = local_delivery
5990 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5991 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5992 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5993 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5994 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5997 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5998 .cindex "default" "transports"
5999 .cindex "transports" "default"
6000 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6001 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6002 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6006 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6012 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6013 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6014 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6015 It is negotiated between client and server
6016 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6017 All other options are defaulted.
6021 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6028 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6029 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6030 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6031 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6032 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6033 show how this can be done.
6035 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6036 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6037 similarly-named options above.
6043 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6044 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6045 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
6054 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6055 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6056 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6061 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6066 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6067 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6068 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6069 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6070 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6071 introduced by the line
6075 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6078 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6080 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6081 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6082 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6083 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6085 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6086 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6087 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6090 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6091 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6095 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6096 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6100 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6101 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6102 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6104 begin authenticators
6106 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6107 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6108 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6109 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6110 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6111 to support most MUA software.
6113 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6116 # driver = plaintext
6117 # server_set_id = $auth2
6118 # server_prompts = :
6119 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6120 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6122 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6125 # driver = plaintext
6126 # server_set_id = $auth1
6127 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6128 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6129 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6132 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6133 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6134 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6135 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6136 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6137 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6138 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6139 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6141 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6142 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6143 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6144 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6146 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6147 usercode and password are in different positions.
6148 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6150 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6154 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6155 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6157 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6159 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6161 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6162 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6163 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6164 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6165 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6166 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6168 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6169 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6170 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6171 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6172 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6175 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6176 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6177 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6178 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6180 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6182 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6183 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6184 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6185 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6186 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6187 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6190 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6191 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6192 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6193 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6194 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6195 match anywhere in the subject string.
6197 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6198 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6200 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6202 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6205 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6207 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6208 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6212 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6213 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6215 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6216 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6217 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6218 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6219 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6220 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6223 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6224 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6225 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6226 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6227 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6229 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6230 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6231 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6232 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6233 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6236 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6237 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6238 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6239 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6240 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6241 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6243 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6244 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6245 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6246 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6247 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6249 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6250 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6252 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6253 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6254 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6255 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6256 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6258 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6259 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6261 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6262 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6264 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6265 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6266 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6271 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6272 matches the list item.
6274 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6275 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6277 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6279 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6280 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6281 causes a second lookup to occur.
6283 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6284 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6285 lookup is permitted.
6288 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6289 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6290 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6291 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6294 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6295 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6296 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6298 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6299 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6300 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6301 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6304 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6305 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6306 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6311 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6312 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6313 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6318 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6319 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6320 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6321 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6324 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6325 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6326 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6327 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6328 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6329 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6330 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6331 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6332 be found in several places:
6334 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6335 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6336 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6338 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6339 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6340 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6341 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6343 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6344 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6345 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6346 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6347 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6348 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6349 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6351 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6352 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6353 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6354 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6355 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6356 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6357 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6359 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6360 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6362 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6363 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6364 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6365 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6366 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6367 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6368 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6370 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6371 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6372 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6374 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6375 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6376 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6377 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6378 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6379 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6380 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6381 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6382 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6383 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6385 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6386 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6387 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6388 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6389 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6390 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6391 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6392 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6393 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6395 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6396 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6397 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6398 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6399 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6400 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6401 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6403 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6404 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6405 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6406 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6408 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6409 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6410 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6411 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6412 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6414 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6415 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6416 lookup types support only literal keys.
6418 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6419 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6420 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6422 .cindex "linear search"
6423 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6424 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6425 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6426 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6427 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6428 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6429 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6430 in the file is used.
6432 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6433 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6434 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6435 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6436 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6441 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6442 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6443 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6444 wildcarding of any kind.
6446 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6447 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6448 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6449 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6450 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6451 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6452 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6453 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6454 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6457 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6458 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6459 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6460 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6461 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6462 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6463 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6464 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6467 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6468 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6469 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6470 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6471 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6472 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6473 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6474 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6475 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6477 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6478 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6479 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6480 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6482 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6483 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6486 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6488 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6489 *fish data for anythingfish
6492 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6493 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6495 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6497 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6498 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6499 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6501 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6503 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6504 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6505 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6507 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6510 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6511 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6512 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6513 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6514 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6516 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6517 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6518 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6519 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6520 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6523 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6524 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6525 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6528 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6530 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6533 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6534 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6535 be followed by optional colons.
6537 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6538 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6539 lookup types support only literal keys.
6543 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6544 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6545 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6546 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6547 many of them are given in later sections.
6550 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6551 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6552 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6553 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6554 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6556 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6557 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6558 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6560 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6561 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6562 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6563 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6564 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6565 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6566 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6568 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6569 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6570 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6571 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6573 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6574 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6575 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6576 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6578 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6579 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6580 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6581 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6583 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6584 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6585 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6586 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6587 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6588 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6589 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6590 password value. For example:
6592 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6595 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6596 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6597 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6598 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6601 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6602 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6603 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6604 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6607 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6608 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6610 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6611 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6612 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6613 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6614 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6615 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6616 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6617 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6618 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6620 require condition = \
6621 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6623 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6624 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6625 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6626 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6631 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6632 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6633 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6634 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6635 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6636 options such as a list of local domains.
6638 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6639 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6640 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6641 or may give up altogether.
6645 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6646 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6647 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6648 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6649 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6650 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6651 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6652 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6654 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6655 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6656 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6658 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6659 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6660 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6662 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6663 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6664 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6665 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6666 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6667 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6668 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6669 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6670 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6671 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6673 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6675 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6676 looks up these keys, in this order:
6682 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6683 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6684 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6685 Exim move on to try the next key.
6689 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6690 .cindex "partial matching"
6691 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6692 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6693 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6694 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6695 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6696 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6697 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6698 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6699 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6700 a key in a DBM file is
6702 *.dates.fict.example
6704 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6705 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6706 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6709 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6710 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6711 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6713 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6714 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6715 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6716 partial matching keys
6717 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6718 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6719 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6721 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6722 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6723 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6724 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6725 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6726 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6729 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6730 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6731 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6732 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6733 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6734 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6736 2250.dates.fict.example
6737 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6738 *.dates.fict.example
6741 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6744 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6745 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6746 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6747 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6748 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6749 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6751 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6753 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6754 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6755 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6756 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6758 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6760 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6761 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6763 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6764 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6765 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6768 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6770 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6771 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6773 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6774 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6775 for &"*"& on its own.
6777 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6781 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6782 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6783 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6784 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6785 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6786 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6787 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6789 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6790 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6791 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6792 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6793 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6798 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6799 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6800 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6801 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6802 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6803 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6804 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6806 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6807 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6808 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6809 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6810 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6811 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6813 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6814 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6820 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6821 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6822 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6823 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6824 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6825 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6829 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6830 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6832 [name="$local_part"]
6834 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6835 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6836 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6837 of the following form is provided:
6839 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6841 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6843 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6845 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6846 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6847 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6852 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6853 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6854 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6855 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6856 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6857 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6858 an expansion string could contain:
6860 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6862 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6863 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6864 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6865 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6867 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SPF, SRV, TLSA and TXT,
6868 and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6869 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6870 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6871 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6873 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6875 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6876 altered and nothing is added.
6878 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6879 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6880 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6881 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6882 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6883 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6885 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6887 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6888 white space is ignored.
6890 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6891 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6892 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6893 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6894 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6896 An alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
6897 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
6900 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6901 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6902 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6903 unless a separator for them is specified using a comma after the separator
6904 character followed immediately by the TXT record item separator. To concatenate
6905 items without a separator, use a semicolon instead. For SPF records the
6906 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6908 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6909 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6910 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6912 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6913 white space is ignored.
6915 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6916 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6917 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6918 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6919 the pseudo-type MXH:
6921 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6923 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6926 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6927 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6928 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6929 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6930 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6931 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6932 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6933 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6935 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6936 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6938 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6939 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6940 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6942 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6943 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6944 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6945 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6946 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6949 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6950 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6951 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6952 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6953 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6954 result of a successful lookup such as:
6956 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6958 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6959 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6960 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6962 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6963 The pseudo-type A+ performs an A6 lookup (if configured) followed by an AAAA
6964 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
6965 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
6967 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
6971 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6972 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6973 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6974 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6975 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6977 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6978 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6979 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6981 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6982 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6983 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6984 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6986 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6987 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6988 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6990 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are givien by optional keywords,
6991 each followed by a comma,
6992 that may appear before the record type.
6994 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6995 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6996 a defer-option modifier.
6997 The possible keywords are
6998 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
6999 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7000 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7001 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7002 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7003 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7004 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7006 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7007 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7009 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7010 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7012 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7013 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7014 The possible keywords are
7015 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7016 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7018 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7019 is not labelled as authenticated data
7020 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7021 The default is &"never"&.
7023 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7028 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7029 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7030 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7031 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7032 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7033 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7034 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7035 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7036 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7037 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7038 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7039 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7041 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7042 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7043 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7044 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7045 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7047 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7048 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7050 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7051 the way they handle the results of a query:
7054 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7057 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7058 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7060 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7061 from all of them are returned.
7065 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7066 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7067 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7068 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7071 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7072 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7073 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7074 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7076 data = ${lookup ldap \
7077 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7078 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7080 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7081 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7082 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7083 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7085 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7086 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7087 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7089 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7090 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7091 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7092 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7093 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7094 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7095 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7096 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7100 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7101 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7102 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7103 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7104 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7105 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7107 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7108 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7116 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7117 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7121 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7123 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7127 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7129 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7131 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7133 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7134 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7135 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7139 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7140 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7141 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7143 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7147 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7149 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7151 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7153 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7154 authentication below.
7157 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7158 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7159 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7160 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7161 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7164 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7166 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7167 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7168 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7169 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7170 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7171 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7172 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7173 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7174 failures, and timeouts.
7176 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7177 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7178 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7179 doubled. For example
7181 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7183 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7184 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7185 the local host) is used.
7187 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7188 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7189 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7190 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7193 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7194 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7195 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7196 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7198 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7200 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7201 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7203 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7205 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7206 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7207 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7208 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7209 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7210 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7211 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7214 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7215 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7216 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7219 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7222 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7226 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7227 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7231 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7232 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7233 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7234 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7235 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7236 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7237 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7238 them. The following names are recognized:
7240 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7241 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7242 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7243 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7244 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7245 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7246 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7247 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7249 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7250 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7251 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7252 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7254 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7255 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7256 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7257 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7258 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7259 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7260 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7261 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7262 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7264 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7265 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7267 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7268 to use for an individual lookup. The global ldap_servers option provides a
7269 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7270 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7271 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7272 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7273 alternate list (colon-separated).
7275 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7276 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7279 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7280 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7283 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7284 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7285 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7286 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7288 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7289 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7290 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7292 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7293 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7294 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7295 quoting has two advantages:
7298 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7299 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7301 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7304 For example, a setting such as
7306 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7308 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7310 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7311 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7312 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7313 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7317 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7318 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7323 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7324 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7325 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7326 as a sequence of values, for example
7328 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7330 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7331 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7332 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7333 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7334 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7337 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7338 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7339 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7341 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7342 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7343 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7344 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7346 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7347 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7349 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7350 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7351 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7354 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7355 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7356 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7357 &%attr2%& has only one value:
7359 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7362 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7365 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7366 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7368 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7369 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7373 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7374 results of LDAP lookups.
7375 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7376 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7378 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7379 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7380 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7381 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7387 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7388 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7389 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7390 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7391 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7392 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7393 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7394 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7396 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7398 might return the string
7400 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7401 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7403 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7405 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7411 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7412 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7413 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7417 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7418 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7419 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7420 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7421 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7422 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7423 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7424 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7425 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7426 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7427 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7428 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7431 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7434 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7435 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7437 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7442 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7444 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7445 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7446 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7450 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7451 with a newline between the data for each row.
7454 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7455 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7456 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7457 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7458 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7459 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7460 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7461 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7462 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7463 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7464 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7465 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7467 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7468 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7469 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7470 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7471 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7472 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7474 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7476 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7477 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7478 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7480 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7481 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7483 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7484 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7485 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7486 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7487 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7488 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7490 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7491 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7492 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7493 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7494 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7495 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7496 characters are not special.
7498 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7499 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7500 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7501 done by starting the query with
7503 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7505 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7507 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7508 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7509 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7512 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7514 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7515 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7516 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7518 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7519 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7520 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7523 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7527 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7529 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7531 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7532 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7533 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7535 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7539 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7540 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7541 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7542 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7543 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7545 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7546 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7548 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7549 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7551 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7554 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7555 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7557 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7558 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7559 is zero because no rows are affected.
7562 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7563 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7564 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7565 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7566 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7569 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7571 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7572 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7573 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7575 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7576 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7579 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7580 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7581 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7582 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7583 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7584 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7585 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7586 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7587 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7589 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7590 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7592 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7594 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7595 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7597 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7598 quote, which it doubles.
7600 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7601 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7602 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7603 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7604 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7605 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7611 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7612 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7614 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7615 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7616 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7617 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7618 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7619 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7620 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7621 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7622 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7624 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7625 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7626 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7627 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7631 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7632 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7633 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7634 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7635 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7636 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7637 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7638 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7641 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7642 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7643 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7645 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7646 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7647 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7648 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7649 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7651 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7652 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7654 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7655 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7656 senders based on the receiving domain.
7661 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7662 .cindex "list" "negation"
7663 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7664 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7665 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7666 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7667 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7668 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7670 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7671 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7672 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7673 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7674 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7676 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7678 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7679 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7680 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7682 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7684 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7685 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7686 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7688 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7689 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7694 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7695 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7696 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7697 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7698 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7699 file names are not allowed,
7700 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7701 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7705 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7706 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7708 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7709 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7710 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7712 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7716 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7717 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7718 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7719 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7721 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7722 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7724 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7726 and the file contains the lines
7731 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7732 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7736 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7737 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7738 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7739 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7740 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7741 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7742 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7743 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7745 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7746 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7747 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7748 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7753 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7754 .cindex "named lists"
7755 .cindex "list" "named"
7756 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7757 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7758 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7759 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7760 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7761 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7762 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7764 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7766 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7767 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7768 configured with the line
7770 domains = +local_domains
7772 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7773 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7777 domains = ! +local_domains
7778 transport = remote_smtp
7781 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7782 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7783 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7784 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7786 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7787 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7789 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7791 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7792 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7793 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7795 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7796 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7797 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7799 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7800 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7802 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7803 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7804 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7806 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7808 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7809 referenced lists if you can.
7811 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7812 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7813 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7815 domains = +local_domains
7817 on several of your routers
7818 or in several ACL statements,
7819 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7820 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7821 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7822 the same each time they are referenced.
7824 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7825 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7826 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7827 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7831 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7832 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7833 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7834 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7835 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7838 ALIST = host1 : host2
7839 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7841 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7843 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7845 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7848 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7849 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7851 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7853 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7857 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7858 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7859 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7860 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7861 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7862 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7863 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7864 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7865 message. For example:
7867 domainlist special_domains = \
7868 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7870 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7871 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7872 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7873 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7874 same list each time.
7876 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7877 cache the result anyway. For example:
7879 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7881 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7882 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7886 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7887 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7888 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7889 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7890 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7893 .cindex "primary host name"
7894 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7895 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7896 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7897 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7898 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7899 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7900 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7901 differ only in their names.
7903 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7904 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7905 .cindex "domain literal"
7906 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7907 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7908 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7909 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7910 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7911 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7914 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7915 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7916 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7917 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7918 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7919 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7920 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7921 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7922 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7923 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7924 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7926 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7927 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7928 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7929 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7930 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7932 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7933 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7934 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7935 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7936 on a router). For example:
7938 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7940 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7941 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7943 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7944 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7945 contain negative items.
7947 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7948 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7949 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7951 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7952 an.other.domain : ...
7954 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7955 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7957 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7958 an.other.domain ? ...
7961 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7962 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7963 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7964 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7965 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7966 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7967 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7968 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7969 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7973 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7974 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7975 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7976 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7977 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7978 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7979 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7980 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7981 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7983 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7984 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7985 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7986 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7987 expression by expansion, of course).
7989 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7990 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7991 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7992 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7993 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7994 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7996 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7998 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7999 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8000 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8001 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8002 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8003 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8004 other statements in the same ACL.
8007 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8008 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8010 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8012 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8013 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8016 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8017 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8018 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8019 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8020 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8021 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8024 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8025 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8026 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8027 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8029 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8030 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8032 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8033 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8034 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8035 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8036 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8038 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8039 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8040 between the pattern and the domain.
8043 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8045 domainlist funny_domains = \
8048 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8049 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8050 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8051 nis;domains.byname : \
8052 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8054 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8055 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8056 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8057 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8058 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8063 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8064 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8065 .cindex "list" "host list"
8066 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8067 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8068 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8069 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8070 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8071 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8072 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8075 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8076 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8077 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8078 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8079 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8080 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8083 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8084 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8085 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8089 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8090 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8091 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8092 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8093 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8094 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8095 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8098 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8099 inspecting its IP address:
8102 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8103 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8104 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8105 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8106 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8107 with the IP address of the subject host.
8109 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8110 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8111 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8112 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8113 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8116 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8117 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8118 domain name, as just described.
8121 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8122 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8123 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8124 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8125 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8126 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8127 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8128 that can never match a client host.
8131 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8132 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8133 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8134 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8136 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8140 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8141 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8142 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8143 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8144 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8145 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8146 significant end of the address.
8148 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8149 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8150 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8151 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8155 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8156 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8159 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8161 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8162 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8164 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8165 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8168 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8170 could make use of a file containing
8175 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8176 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8177 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8179 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8182 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8188 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8189 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8190 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8191 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8192 address, the pattern takes this form:
8194 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8198 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8200 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8201 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8202 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8203 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8204 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8205 returned by the lookup is not used.
8207 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8208 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8209 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8210 patterns of this form:
8212 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8216 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8218 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8219 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8220 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8221 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8222 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8224 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8225 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8226 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8227 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8228 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8229 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8230 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8231 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8232 addresses are always used.
8234 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8235 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8236 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8239 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8240 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8241 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8242 case the IP address is used on its own.
8246 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8247 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8248 .cindex "unknown host name"
8249 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8250 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8251 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8252 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8253 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8256 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8257 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8258 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8259 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8260 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8261 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8262 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8264 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8265 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8267 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8268 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8269 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8270 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8271 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8272 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8273 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8274 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8275 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8277 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8278 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8280 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8281 .cindex "alias for host"
8282 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8283 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8286 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8287 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8288 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8289 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8290 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8293 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8294 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8295 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8296 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8297 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8298 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8299 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8304 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8305 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8306 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8307 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8308 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8310 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8312 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8313 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8314 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8321 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8322 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8323 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8324 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8325 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8326 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8328 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8329 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8331 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8332 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8333 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8334 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8335 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8336 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8337 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8338 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8339 not recognized in an indirected file).
8342 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8343 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8345 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8347 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8348 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8351 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8352 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8355 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8358 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8359 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8360 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8363 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8364 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8367 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8369 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8371 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8372 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8373 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8376 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8377 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8378 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8380 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8382 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8383 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8384 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8385 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8386 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8387 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8388 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8391 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8392 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8394 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8395 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8397 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8398 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8399 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8404 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8406 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8407 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8408 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8409 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8410 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8411 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8412 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8413 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8414 host lists such as whitelists.
8418 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8419 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8420 .cindex "unknown host name"
8421 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8422 If a pattern is of the form
8424 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8428 dbm;/host/accept/list
8430 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8431 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8434 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8435 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8436 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8437 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8438 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8439 lookup, both using the same file.
8443 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8444 If a pattern is of the form
8446 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8448 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8449 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8450 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8452 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8453 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8455 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8456 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8457 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8460 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8461 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8462 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8464 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8465 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8466 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8467 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8468 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8469 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8475 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8476 .cindex "list" "address list"
8477 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8478 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8479 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8480 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8481 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8482 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8483 using this option setting:
8487 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8488 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8489 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8490 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8492 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8495 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8497 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8498 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8499 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8500 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8501 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8502 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8503 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8505 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8506 *@+hostile_domains:\
8507 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8508 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8510 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8511 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8512 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8513 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8514 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8516 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8517 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8518 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8519 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8520 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8522 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8525 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8526 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8530 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8531 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8532 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8533 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8534 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8535 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8536 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8538 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8539 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8541 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8542 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8545 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8546 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8547 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8550 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8551 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8552 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8554 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8555 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8556 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8557 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8559 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8560 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8562 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8563 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8564 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8565 default. For example, with this lookup:
8567 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8569 the file could contains lines like this:
8571 user1@domain1.example
8574 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8577 nimrod@jaeger.example
8581 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8582 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8584 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8586 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8587 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8589 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8590 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8591 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8595 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8596 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8601 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8602 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8603 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8604 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8605 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8606 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8607 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8608 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8609 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8611 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8612 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8613 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8614 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8615 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8618 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8620 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8622 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8624 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8626 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8627 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8628 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8629 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8630 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8631 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8633 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8636 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8639 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8640 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8641 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8642 might have entries like
8644 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8645 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8648 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8649 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8650 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8651 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8653 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8654 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8655 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8658 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8659 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8660 can only return a single list of local parts.
8663 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8664 in these two examples:
8667 senders = *@+my_list
8669 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8670 example it is a named domain list.
8675 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8676 .cindex "case of local parts"
8677 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8678 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8679 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8680 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8681 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8682 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8683 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8684 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8687 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8688 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8689 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8690 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8691 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8692 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8693 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8696 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8697 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8698 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8699 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8700 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8701 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8702 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8703 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8707 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8708 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8709 .cindex "local part" "list"
8710 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8711 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8712 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8713 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8714 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8715 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8716 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8717 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8719 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8720 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8721 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8722 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8723 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8724 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8725 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8727 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8732 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8733 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8735 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8736 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8737 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8738 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8740 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8741 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8742 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8743 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8744 escape character, as described in the following section.
8746 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8747 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8748 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
8749 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8750 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8755 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8756 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8757 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8758 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8759 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8760 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8761 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8762 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8764 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8765 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8766 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8767 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8769 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8771 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8772 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8777 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8778 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8779 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8780 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8781 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8782 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8783 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8786 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8787 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8788 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8791 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8792 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8793 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8795 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8796 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8797 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8798 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8799 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8800 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8801 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8804 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8805 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8806 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8809 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8810 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8811 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8812 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8814 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8816 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8817 Exim message identifier. For example:
8819 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8821 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8822 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8825 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8826 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8827 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8828 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8829 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8830 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8831 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8832 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8833 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8834 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8835 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8836 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8842 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8843 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8844 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8845 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8846 white space is significant.
8849 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8850 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8851 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8856 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8857 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8858 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8859 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8860 given, the expansion fails.
8862 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8863 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8864 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8865 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8869 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8870 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8871 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8872 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8873 string easier to understand.
8875 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8876 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8877 expansion item below.
8880 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8881 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8882 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8883 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8884 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8885 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8886 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8887 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8888 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
8889 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8890 the result of the expansion.
8891 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
8892 the expansion result is an empty string.
8893 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8896 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
8897 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8898 .cindex "expansion" "extracting cerificate fields"
8899 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
8900 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
8901 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
8902 The field name is expanded and used to retrive the relevant field from
8903 the certificate. Supported fields are:
8907 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
8908 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
8913 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
8917 If the field is found,
8918 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8919 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8920 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8921 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8923 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8924 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8927 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
8929 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
8930 output a Distinguished Name string which is
8932 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
8933 (the exceptions being elements containin commas).
8934 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
8935 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
8936 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
8937 The separator may be changed by another modifer of
8938 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
8939 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
8941 The field selectors marked as "time" above
8942 may output a number of seconds since epoch
8943 if the modifier "int" is used.
8945 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
8946 newline-separated by default,
8947 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
8948 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
8949 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
8951 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
8952 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
8953 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
8954 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
8955 if so the elenment tags are omitted.
8957 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
8959 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8960 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8962 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8963 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8967 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8968 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8969 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8971 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8972 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8973 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8974 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8975 must have the following type:
8977 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8979 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8980 function should return one of the following values:
8982 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8983 into the expanded string that is being built.
8985 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8986 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8988 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8989 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8991 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8993 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8994 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8995 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8997 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8998 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8999 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9000 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9001 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9002 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9003 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
9006 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9009 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9010 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9011 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9012 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9013 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9014 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9015 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9016 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9017 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9019 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9020 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9021 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9024 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9025 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9027 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9028 appear, for example:
9030 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9032 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9033 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9036 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9037 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9038 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9039 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9040 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9041 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9042 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9043 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9044 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9045 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9046 <&'string3'&> as before.
9048 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9049 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9050 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9051 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9052 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9053 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9054 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9055 provided. For example:
9057 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9061 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9063 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9064 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9067 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9068 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9069 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9071 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9072 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9073 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9074 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9075 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9076 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9077 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9079 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9081 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9082 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9085 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9086 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9087 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9088 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9089 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9090 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9092 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9093 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9094 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9095 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9097 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9099 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9100 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9101 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9102 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9103 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9105 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9107 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9108 letters appear. For example:
9110 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9111 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9112 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9115 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9116 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9117 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9118 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9119 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9120 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9121 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9122 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9123 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9124 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9125 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9126 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9127 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9128 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9132 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9133 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9134 lines) may be present.
9136 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9137 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9140 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9141 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9142 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9145 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9146 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9147 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9148 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9149 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9150 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9151 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9152 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9155 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9156 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9157 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9158 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9159 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9160 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9163 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9164 command of the following form:
9166 headers charset "UTF-8"
9168 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9169 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9170 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9171 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9172 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9175 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9176 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9177 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9178 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9180 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9181 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9182 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9183 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9184 router or transport are not accessible.
9186 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9187 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9188 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9189 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9190 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9191 by earlier ACLs are visible.
9193 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9194 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9195 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9196 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
9197 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
9198 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
9199 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
9201 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9202 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9203 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9204 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9205 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9206 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9207 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9208 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9211 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9212 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9214 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9215 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9216 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9217 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9218 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9219 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9220 present. For example:
9222 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9224 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9227 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9229 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9230 an Exim configuration:
9232 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9234 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9237 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9238 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9239 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9241 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9242 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9243 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9244 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9245 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9246 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9249 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9250 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9251 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9252 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9253 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9254 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9256 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9258 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9259 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9260 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9261 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9262 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9264 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9265 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9266 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9268 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9272 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9275 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9276 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9277 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9278 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9279 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9280 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9281 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9284 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9286 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9287 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9288 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9291 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9292 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9293 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9294 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9295 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9296 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9297 apart from an optional leading minus,
9298 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9300 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9301 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9303 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9304 If the number is negative, the fields are
9305 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9306 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9307 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9309 If the modulus of the
9310 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9311 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9315 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9319 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9321 yields &"result: 99"&.
9323 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9324 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9326 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9329 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9330 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9331 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9332 described in the next item.
9334 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9335 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9336 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9337 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9338 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9339 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9340 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9341 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9342 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9344 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9345 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9346 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9347 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9348 out by the system administrator.
9351 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9352 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9353 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9354 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9355 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9356 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9357 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9358 original lookup fails.
9360 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9361 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9362 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9363 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9364 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9365 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9366 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9367 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9369 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9370 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9371 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9372 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9374 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9375 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9376 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9377 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9379 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9381 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9383 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9384 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9386 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9391 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9392 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9394 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9395 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9396 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9397 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9398 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9399 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9401 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9403 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9404 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9405 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9407 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9408 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9409 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9410 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9411 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9412 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9413 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9415 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9417 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9418 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9419 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9420 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9423 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9425 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9429 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9430 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9431 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9432 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9433 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9434 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9435 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9436 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9438 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9439 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9440 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9441 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9442 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9445 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9446 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9447 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9449 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9450 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9453 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9454 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9455 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9456 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9457 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9458 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9459 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9460 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9462 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9463 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9464 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9465 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9466 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9467 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9468 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9469 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9470 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9471 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9473 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9474 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9475 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9476 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9478 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9479 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9480 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9481 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9482 is the expansion of the third argument.
9484 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9485 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9486 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9488 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9489 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9490 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9491 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9492 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9493 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9494 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9495 newlines are left in the string.
9496 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9497 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9498 the string expansion fails.
9500 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9501 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9505 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9506 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9507 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9508 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9509 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9510 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9511 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9514 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9515 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9517 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9518 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9519 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9520 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9521 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9524 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9526 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9527 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9528 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9529 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9530 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9531 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9533 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9535 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9536 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9537 turns them into spaces:
9539 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9541 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9542 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9543 addition, the following errors can occur:
9546 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9548 Failure to connect the socket;
9550 Failure to write the request string;
9552 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9555 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9556 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9557 errors occurs. For example:
9559 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9562 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9563 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9564 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9565 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9566 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9568 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9569 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9572 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9573 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9574 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9577 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9578 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9579 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9580 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9581 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9582 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9583 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9584 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9585 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9587 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9589 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9592 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9594 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9595 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9598 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9599 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9600 expansion item above.
9602 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9603 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9604 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9605 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9606 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9607 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9608 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9609 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9610 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9612 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9613 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9614 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9615 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9616 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9617 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9618 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9619 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9620 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9623 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9624 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9625 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9627 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9628 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9629 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9630 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9631 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9634 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9635 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9636 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9637 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9639 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9640 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9641 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9644 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9645 log_message = Output of id: $value
9647 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9648 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9650 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9654 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9655 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9657 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9658 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9662 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9663 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9666 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9667 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9668 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9669 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9671 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9672 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9675 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9676 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9677 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9678 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9679 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9680 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9681 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9682 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9684 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9686 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9687 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9688 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9690 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9692 yields &"defabc"&, and
9694 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9696 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9697 the regular expression from string expansion.
9702 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9703 .cindex sorting a list
9704 .cindex list sorting
9705 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9706 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9707 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9708 of a two-argument expansion condition.
9709 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9710 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9711 if the first value should sort before the second value.
9712 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9713 the element being placed in &$item$&,
9714 to give values for comparison.
9716 The item result is a sorted list,
9717 with the original list separator,
9718 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
9722 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
9724 sorts a list of numbers, and
9726 ${sort {$lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
9728 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
9732 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9733 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9734 .cindex "substring extraction"
9735 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9736 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9737 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9738 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9739 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9741 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9743 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9744 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9747 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9748 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9749 length required. For example
9751 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9753 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9754 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9755 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9756 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9758 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9759 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9760 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9762 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9764 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9765 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9766 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9768 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9770 yields an empty string, but
9772 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9776 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9777 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9778 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9779 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9782 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9784 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9788 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9789 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9790 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9791 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9792 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9793 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9794 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9795 replacement list. For example
9797 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9799 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9800 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9801 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9807 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9808 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9809 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9810 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9811 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9812 following operations can be performed:
9815 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9816 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9817 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9818 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9819 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9820 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9823 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9824 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9825 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9826 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9827 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9828 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9829 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9830 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9831 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9833 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9834 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9835 character. For example:
9837 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9839 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9840 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9841 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9844 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
9845 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
9846 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
9847 email address seperator. For the example header line:
9849 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
9851 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
9852 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
9853 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
9854 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
9855 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
9856 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
9859 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
9860 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
9862 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
9863 Last:user@example.com
9864 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
9868 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9869 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9870 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9871 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9872 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9873 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9874 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9875 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9876 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9878 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9879 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9880 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9881 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9882 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9883 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9887 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9888 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9889 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9890 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9891 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9894 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9895 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9896 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9897 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9898 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9899 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9900 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9903 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9904 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9905 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9906 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9907 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9908 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9909 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9910 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9911 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9912 C programming language):
9914 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9915 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9916 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9917 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9920 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9922 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9923 space is permitted before or after operators.
9925 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9926 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9927 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9928 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9929 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9931 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
9933 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9934 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
9937 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9938 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9939 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9940 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9941 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
9942 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9943 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9944 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9945 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9946 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
9947 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9950 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9952 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9955 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9958 {$recipients_count} \
9959 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9963 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9964 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9967 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9968 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9969 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9972 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9974 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9975 and then re-expands what it has found.
9978 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9980 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9981 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9982 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9983 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9984 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9985 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9986 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9987 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9988 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9990 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9991 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9992 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9993 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9994 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9995 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9996 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9999 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10000 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10001 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10002 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10003 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10004 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10006 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10008 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10009 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10013 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10014 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10015 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10016 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10017 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10018 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10022 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10023 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10024 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10025 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10026 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10027 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10028 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10031 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10032 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10033 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10034 .cindex "lower casing"
10035 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10036 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10037 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10042 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10043 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10044 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10045 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10046 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10047 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10049 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10051 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10052 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10053 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10056 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10057 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10058 .cindex "list" "item count"
10059 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10060 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10061 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10064 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10065 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10066 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10067 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10068 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10069 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10070 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10071 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10072 matching list is returned.
10075 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10076 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10077 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10078 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10079 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10083 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10084 .cindex "masked IP address"
10085 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10086 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10087 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10088 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10089 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10090 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10091 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10092 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10093 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10095 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10097 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10098 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10099 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10100 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10102 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10106 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10108 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10111 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10113 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10114 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10115 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10116 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10117 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10120 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10121 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10122 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10123 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10124 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10125 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10127 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10129 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10132 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10133 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10134 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10135 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10136 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10137 is an empty string or
10138 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10139 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10140 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10141 respectively For example,
10149 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10150 variable or a message header.
10152 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10153 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10154 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10155 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10156 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10157 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10158 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10161 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10162 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10163 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10164 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10165 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10167 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10173 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10174 yields an unchanged string.
10177 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10178 .cindex "random number"
10179 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10180 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10181 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10182 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10183 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10184 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10185 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10186 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10190 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10191 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10192 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10193 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
10194 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10195 for DNS. For example,
10197 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10198 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10203 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10207 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10208 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10209 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10210 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10211 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10212 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10213 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10214 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
10215 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10218 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10220 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10221 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10225 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10226 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10227 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10228 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10229 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10230 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10231 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10232 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10234 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10235 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10236 to use this operator as well.
10240 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10241 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10242 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10243 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10244 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10245 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10246 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10249 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10250 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10251 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10252 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10253 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10254 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10255 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10258 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'certificate'&>&*}*&
10259 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10260 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10261 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10262 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10263 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the
10266 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10267 Only arguments which are a single variable of certificate type are supported.
10270 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10271 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10272 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10273 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10274 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10275 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10276 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10277 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10278 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10279 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10280 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10281 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10282 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10284 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10285 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10286 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10288 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10289 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10290 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10291 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10292 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10296 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10297 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10298 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10299 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10300 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10301 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10304 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10305 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10306 .cindex "substring extraction"
10307 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10308 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10309 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10310 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10312 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10314 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10315 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10317 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10318 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10319 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10320 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10323 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10324 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10325 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10326 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10327 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10328 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10331 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10332 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10333 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10334 .cindex "upper casing"
10335 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10336 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10337 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10339 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10340 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10341 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10342 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10343 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10344 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10345 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10353 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10354 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10355 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10356 while expanding strings:
10359 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10360 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10361 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10362 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10365 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10366 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10367 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10368 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10374 &`>= `& greater or equal
10376 &`<= `& less or equal
10380 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10382 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10383 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10384 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10385 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10386 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10389 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10390 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10391 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10394 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10395 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10396 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10397 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10398 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10399 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10400 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10401 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10402 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10403 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10404 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10405 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10406 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10407 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10409 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10410 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10411 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10412 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10413 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10414 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10416 An empty string is treated as false.
10417 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10418 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10419 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10421 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10422 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10425 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10429 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10430 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10431 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10432 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10433 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10434 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10435 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10436 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10438 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10440 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10441 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10442 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10443 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10444 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10445 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10446 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10447 included in the binary.
10449 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10450 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10451 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10452 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10453 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10454 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10455 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10456 string in LDAP form is:
10458 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10460 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10461 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10463 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10465 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10470 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10471 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10472 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10473 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10474 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10475 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10479 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10480 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10481 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10482 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10483 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10484 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10487 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10488 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10489 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10490 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10491 whatever its length.
10494 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10495 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10496 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10497 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10499 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10500 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10501 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10502 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10503 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10504 support &[crypt16()]&.
10506 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10507 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10508 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10509 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10510 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10512 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10513 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10514 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10516 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10517 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10518 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10519 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10520 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10522 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10523 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10524 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10525 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10526 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10527 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10529 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10531 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10532 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10534 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10535 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10536 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10537 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10538 exists in the message. For example,
10540 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10542 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10543 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10545 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10546 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10547 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10548 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10549 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10550 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10551 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10552 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10553 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10555 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10556 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10557 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10558 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10559 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10560 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10561 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10562 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10564 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10565 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10566 .cindex "first delivery"
10567 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10568 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10569 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10570 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10573 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10574 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10575 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10576 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10577 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10579 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10580 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10581 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10582 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10583 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10585 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10586 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10587 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10589 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10590 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10591 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10593 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10594 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10595 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10596 list separator is changed to a comma:
10598 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10600 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10601 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10603 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10606 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10607 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10608 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10609 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10610 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10611 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10612 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10613 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10614 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10617 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10618 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10619 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10620 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10621 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10622 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10623 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10624 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10625 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10628 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10629 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10630 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10631 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10632 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10633 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10636 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10637 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10639 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10640 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10641 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10642 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10645 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10646 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10647 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10648 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10649 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10650 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10651 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10652 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10653 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10654 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10655 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10657 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10658 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10659 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10660 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10661 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10663 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10664 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10665 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10666 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10668 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10670 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10672 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10673 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10674 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10675 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10676 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10677 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10678 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10679 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10680 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10681 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10682 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10683 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10684 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10688 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10689 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10690 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10691 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10692 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10693 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10694 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10695 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10696 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10699 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10700 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10701 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10702 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10703 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10704 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10705 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10706 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10707 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10711 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10712 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10713 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10714 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10715 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10716 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10717 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10718 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10719 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10720 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10721 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10724 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10726 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10727 backslashes is also required.
10729 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10730 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10731 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10732 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10733 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10734 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10736 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10737 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10738 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10739 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10740 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10741 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10742 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10743 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10745 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10746 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10747 See &*match_local_part*&.
10749 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10750 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10751 See &*match_local_part*&.
10753 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10754 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10755 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10756 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10757 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10758 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10760 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10762 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10765 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10767 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10769 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10770 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10771 in a single test such as
10772 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10773 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10774 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10775 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10777 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10779 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10781 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10783 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10784 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10785 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10786 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10787 masks. For example:
10789 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10791 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10792 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10793 address mask, for example:
10795 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10797 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10798 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10800 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10804 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10805 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10807 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10809 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10810 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10811 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10812 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10813 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10814 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10815 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10816 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10819 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10821 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10822 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10823 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10824 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10826 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10828 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10829 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10830 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10831 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10834 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10835 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10837 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10838 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10839 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10840 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10842 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10843 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10844 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10845 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10846 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10847 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10848 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10849 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10850 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10851 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10852 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10856 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10857 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10859 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10860 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10861 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10862 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10863 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10864 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10865 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10867 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10868 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10869 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10870 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10871 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10873 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10875 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10877 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10879 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10880 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10881 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10882 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10883 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10884 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10885 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10886 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10889 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10890 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10892 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10893 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10894 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10895 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10896 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10897 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10899 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10900 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10901 building Exim. For example:
10903 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10905 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10906 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10907 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10908 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10910 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10911 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10912 configuration, you might have this:
10914 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10916 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10918 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10920 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10921 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10922 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10923 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10924 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10925 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10928 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10930 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10931 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10932 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10933 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10934 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10937 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10938 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10939 this library, you need to set
10941 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10943 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10944 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10946 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10948 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10949 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10950 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10952 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10953 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10954 the authentication is successful. For example:
10956 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10960 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10961 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10962 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10964 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10965 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10966 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10967 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10968 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10969 by a process that is not running as root.
10971 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10972 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10973 building Exim. For example:
10975 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10977 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10978 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10979 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10981 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10982 two are mandatory. For example:
10984 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10986 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10987 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10988 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10993 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10994 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10995 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10996 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10997 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10998 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10999 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11003 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11004 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11005 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11006 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11007 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11010 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11012 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11013 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11014 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11016 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11017 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11018 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11019 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11020 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11021 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11022 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11023 parsed but not evaluated.
11025 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11030 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11031 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11032 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11033 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11034 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11037 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11038 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11039 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11040 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11041 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11042 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11043 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11044 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11045 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11046 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11047 matching condition.
11049 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11050 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11051 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11052 any unused variables being made empty.
11054 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11055 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11056 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11057 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11058 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11059 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11060 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11061 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11062 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11063 during subsequent delivery.
11065 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11066 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11067 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11068 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11069 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11070 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11071 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11072 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11075 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11076 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11077 this variable has the number of arguments.
11079 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11080 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11081 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11082 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11083 be preserved by coding like this:
11085 warn !verify = sender
11086 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11088 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11089 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11092 .vitem &$address_data$&
11093 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11094 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11095 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11096 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11097 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11098 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11101 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11102 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11103 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11104 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11105 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11106 from the child's routing.
11108 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11109 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11110 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11113 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11114 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11115 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11117 .vitem &$address_file$&
11118 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11119 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11120 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11121 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11122 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11124 /home/r2d2/savemail
11126 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11127 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11128 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11129 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11130 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11131 to the relevant file.
11133 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11134 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11135 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11136 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11138 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11139 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11140 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11141 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11143 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11144 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11145 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11146 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11147 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11148 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11149 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11150 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11151 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11152 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11153 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11154 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11155 command line option.
11157 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11158 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11159 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11160 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11161 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11162 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11163 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11164 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11165 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11169 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11170 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11171 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11172 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11173 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11174 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11175 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11176 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11177 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11178 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11179 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11181 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11182 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11183 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11184 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11185 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11188 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11189 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11190 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11191 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11192 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11193 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11194 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11195 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11196 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11197 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11198 an undefined mechanism.
11200 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11201 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11202 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11203 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11204 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11205 the ACL malware condition.
11207 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11208 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11209 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11210 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11211 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11212 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11214 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11215 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11216 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11217 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11218 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11219 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11220 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11222 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11223 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11224 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11225 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11226 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11228 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11229 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11230 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11231 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11232 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11234 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11235 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11236 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11237 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11238 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11239 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11240 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11242 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11243 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11244 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11245 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11246 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11247 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11248 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11250 .vitem &$compile_date$&
11251 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
11252 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
11254 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11255 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11256 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11257 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11258 compilations of the same version of the program.
11260 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11261 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11262 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11263 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11264 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11266 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
11267 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11268 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11269 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11270 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11272 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11273 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11274 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11276 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11277 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11278 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11279 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11280 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11281 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11282 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11283 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11284 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11287 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11288 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11289 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11290 case for &$domain$&.
11292 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11293 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11294 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11295 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11297 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11298 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11299 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11300 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11301 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11302 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11304 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11305 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11306 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11308 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11311 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11312 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11313 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11314 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11315 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11316 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11317 the &(smtp)& transport.
11320 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11321 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11322 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11323 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11326 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11327 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11328 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11329 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11330 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11331 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11334 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11335 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11336 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11337 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11341 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11342 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11343 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11344 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11345 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11346 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11347 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11350 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11351 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11352 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11355 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11356 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11357 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11359 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11360 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11361 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11363 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11364 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11365 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11367 .vitem &$found_extension$&
11368 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11369 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11370 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11371 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11373 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11374 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11375 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11376 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11377 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11379 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11380 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11381 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11382 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11383 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11387 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11388 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11389 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11390 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11391 by a setting on the transport itself.
11393 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11394 of the environment variable HOME.
11398 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11399 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11400 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11401 to local and remote transports.
11403 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11404 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11405 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11406 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11407 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11408 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11409 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11412 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11413 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11414 client is connected.
11417 .vitem &$host_address$&
11418 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11419 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11420 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11421 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11423 .vitem &$host_data$&
11424 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11425 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11426 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11427 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11429 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11430 message = $host_data
11432 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11433 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11434 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11435 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11436 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11437 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11438 variables is set to &"1"&.
11441 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11442 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11445 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11446 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11447 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11450 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11451 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11452 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11453 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11454 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11455 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11456 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11457 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11458 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11459 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11461 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11462 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11463 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11465 .vitem &$host_port$&
11466 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11467 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11468 for an outbound connection.
11472 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11473 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11474 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11475 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11476 a unique name for the file.
11478 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11479 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11480 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11482 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11483 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11484 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11488 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11489 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11490 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11494 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11495 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11496 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11499 .vitem &$load_average$&
11500 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11501 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11502 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11503 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11505 .vitem &$local_part$&
11506 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11507 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11508 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11509 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11510 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11512 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11513 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11514 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11515 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11518 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11519 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11520 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11521 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11522 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11523 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11525 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11526 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11527 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11530 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11531 local part of the recipient address.
11533 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11534 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11535 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11537 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11540 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11541 abc\:xyz@test.example
11543 the value of &$local_part$& is
11547 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11548 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11551 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11553 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11554 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11555 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11557 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11558 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11559 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11560 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11561 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11562 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11563 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11565 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11566 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11567 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11568 variable expands to nothing.
11570 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11571 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11572 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11573 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11574 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11576 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11577 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11578 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11579 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11580 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11582 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11583 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11584 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11585 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11587 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11588 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11589 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11591 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11592 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11593 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11594 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11595 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11596 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11597 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11598 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11600 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11601 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11602 This contains the expanded value of the
11603 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11606 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11607 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11608 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11609 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11610 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11611 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11613 .vitem &$log_space$&
11614 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11615 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11616 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11617 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11618 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11619 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11622 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
11623 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
11624 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
11625 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
11626 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
11627 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
11628 and &"yes"& if it was.
11630 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11631 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11632 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11633 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11634 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11635 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11636 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11639 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11640 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11641 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11642 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11643 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11645 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11646 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11647 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11648 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11649 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11650 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11653 .vitem &$message_age$&
11654 .cindex "message" "age of"
11655 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11656 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11657 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11660 .vitem &$message_body$&
11661 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11662 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11663 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11664 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11665 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11666 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11667 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11668 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11669 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11671 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11672 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11673 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11674 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11675 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11677 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11678 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11679 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11680 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11681 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11682 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11685 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11686 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11687 .cindex "message body" "size"
11688 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11689 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11690 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11691 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11692 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11694 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11695 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11696 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11697 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11698 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11699 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11700 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11701 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11703 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11704 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11705 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11706 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11707 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11708 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11710 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11711 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11712 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11713 contents of header lines is done.
11715 .vitem &$message_id$&
11716 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
11718 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11719 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11720 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11721 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11722 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11723 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11724 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11725 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11726 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11727 from the body is not counted.
11729 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11730 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11731 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11732 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11733 header and the body).
11735 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11737 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11739 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11741 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11742 message has not yet been received.
11744 .vitem &$message_size$&
11745 .cindex "size" "of message"
11746 .cindex "message" "size"
11747 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11748 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11749 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11750 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11751 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11752 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11753 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11754 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11755 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11757 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11758 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11759 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11760 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11762 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11763 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11764 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11765 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11767 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11768 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11769 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11771 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11772 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11773 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11774 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11775 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11776 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11777 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11778 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11779 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11780 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11782 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11783 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11784 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11786 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11787 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11788 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11789 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11790 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11791 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11792 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11793 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11794 the original address.
11796 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11797 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11798 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11799 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11800 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11802 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11803 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11804 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11806 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11807 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11808 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11809 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11810 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11811 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11812 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11813 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11814 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11816 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11817 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11818 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11819 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11820 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11821 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11822 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11823 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11826 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11827 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11828 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11829 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11831 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11832 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11833 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11834 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11837 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11839 This variable contains the current process id.
11841 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11842 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11843 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11844 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11845 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11846 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11847 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11848 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11849 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11850 variable"& error if encountered.
11852 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11853 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11854 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11855 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11856 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11857 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11858 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11861 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11862 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11863 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11864 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11866 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11867 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11868 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11869 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11871 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11872 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11873 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11874 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11876 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11877 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11878 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11880 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11881 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11882 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11883 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11885 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11886 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11887 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11888 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11889 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11891 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11892 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11893 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11894 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11895 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11896 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11898 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11899 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11900 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11901 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11902 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11904 .vitem &$received_count$&
11905 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11906 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11907 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11908 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11911 .vitem &$received_for$&
11912 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11913 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11914 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11915 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11916 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11918 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11919 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11920 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11921 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11922 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11923 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11924 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11927 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11928 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11929 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11930 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11931 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11934 &*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11935 the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11936 &(smtp)& transport).
11938 .vitem &$received_port$&
11939 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11940 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11942 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11943 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11944 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11945 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11946 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11947 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11948 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11949 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11950 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11952 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11953 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11954 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11955 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11956 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11957 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11959 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11960 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11961 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11963 .vitem &$received_time$&
11964 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11965 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11966 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11968 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
11969 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11970 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11971 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11972 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11974 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11975 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11977 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11978 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11979 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11980 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11982 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11983 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11984 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11985 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11988 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11989 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11992 &"route"&: Routing failed.
11995 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11996 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12000 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12003 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12006 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12007 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12009 .vitem &$recipients$&
12010 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12011 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12012 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12013 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12014 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12018 In a system filter file.
12020 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12021 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12022 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12023 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12025 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12029 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12030 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12031 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12032 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12033 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12034 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12037 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12038 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12039 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12040 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12043 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12044 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12045 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12046 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12047 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12048 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12049 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12051 .vitem &$return_path$&
12052 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12053 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12054 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12055 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12056 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12057 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12058 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12059 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12060 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12061 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12064 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12065 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12066 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12068 .vitem &$router_name$&
12069 .cindex "router" "name"
12070 .cindex "name" "of router"
12071 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12072 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12075 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12076 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12077 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12078 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12079 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12080 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12081 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12084 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12085 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12086 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12087 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12088 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12089 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12090 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12091 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12093 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12094 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12095 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12096 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12097 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12098 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12100 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12101 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12102 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12103 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12104 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12105 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12106 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12107 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12109 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12110 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12111 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12113 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12114 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12115 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12117 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12118 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12119 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12120 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12121 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12124 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12125 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12127 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12128 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12129 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12130 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12132 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12133 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12134 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12135 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12136 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12137 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12138 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12139 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12140 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12141 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12142 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12143 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12144 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12146 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12147 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12148 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12149 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12150 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12151 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12153 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12154 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12155 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
12156 host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
12158 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12159 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12160 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12161 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12162 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12163 &$authenticated_id$&.
12165 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12166 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12167 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12168 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12169 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12170 resolver library states that the reverse DNS was authenticated data. At all
12171 other times, this variable is false.
12173 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12174 library, by setting:
12179 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12180 validating resolver (eg, unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12182 Exim does not (currently) check to see if the forward DNS was also secured
12183 with DNSSEC, only the reverse DNS.
12185 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12186 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12189 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12190 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12191 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12192 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12193 other means, this variable is empty.
12195 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12196 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12197 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12198 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12199 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12200 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12201 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12203 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12204 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12205 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12206 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12208 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12209 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12210 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12213 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12214 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12215 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12216 following are true:
12219 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12221 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12222 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12223 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12225 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12226 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12227 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12229 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12230 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12231 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12233 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12234 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12235 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12236 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12238 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12240 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12241 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12245 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12246 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12247 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12248 number that was used on the remote host.
12250 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12251 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12252 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12253 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12254 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12257 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12258 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12259 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12260 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12262 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12263 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12264 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12265 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12266 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12267 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12268 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12269 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12270 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12271 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12272 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12275 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12276 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12277 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12278 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12279 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12281 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12282 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12283 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12284 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12285 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12287 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12288 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12289 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12290 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12291 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12292 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12293 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12295 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12296 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12297 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12298 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12299 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12301 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12302 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12303 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12304 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12305 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12306 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12308 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12309 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12310 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12311 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12312 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12317 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12318 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12319 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12320 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12322 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12323 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12324 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12325 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12326 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12327 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12328 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12330 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12331 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12332 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12333 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12334 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12335 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12336 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12337 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12338 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12339 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12340 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12342 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12343 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12344 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12345 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12346 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12347 message is junk mail.
12349 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12350 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12351 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12352 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12355 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12356 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12357 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12359 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12360 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12361 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12362 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12363 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12364 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12366 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12367 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12368 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12369 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12370 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12371 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12372 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12373 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12375 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12377 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12380 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12381 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12382 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12383 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12384 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12385 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12387 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12388 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12389 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12390 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12391 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12392 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12393 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12394 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12396 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12397 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12400 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12401 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12402 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12403 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12404 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12405 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12407 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12408 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12409 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12410 inbound connection when the message was received.
12411 It is only useful as the argument of a
12413 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12415 or a &%def%& condition.
12417 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12418 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12419 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12420 inbound connection when the message was received.
12421 It is only useful as the argument of a
12423 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12425 or a &%def%& condition.
12427 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12428 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12429 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12430 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12432 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12434 or a &%def%& condition.
12436 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12437 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12438 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12439 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12441 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12443 or a &%def%& condition.
12445 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12446 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12447 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12448 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12450 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verfied$& variable refers to the inbound side
12451 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12454 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12455 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12456 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12457 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12458 and &"0"& otherwise.
12460 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12461 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12462 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12463 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12464 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12465 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12466 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12467 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12468 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12470 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12471 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12472 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12474 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12475 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12477 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12478 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12479 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12480 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12482 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12483 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12484 When a message is received from a remote client connection
12485 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12487 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
12488 1 No response to request
12489 2 Response not verified
12490 3 Verification failed
12491 4 Verification succeeded
12494 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12495 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12496 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12497 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12498 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12500 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12501 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12502 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12503 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12504 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12505 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12506 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12508 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12509 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12512 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12513 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12514 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12515 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12516 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12517 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12519 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12520 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12521 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12522 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12523 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12524 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12525 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12526 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12527 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12528 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12529 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12531 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12532 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12535 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12536 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12537 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12539 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12542 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12543 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12544 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12545 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12547 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12548 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12549 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12551 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12552 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12553 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12555 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12556 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12557 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12558 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12559 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12560 values for those that are behind (west).
12563 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12564 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12565 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12567 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12568 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12569 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12570 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12573 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12574 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12575 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12578 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12579 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12580 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12581 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12583 .vitem &$transport_name$&
12584 .cindex "transport" "name"
12585 .cindex "name" "of transport"
12586 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12587 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12590 .vindex "&$value$&"
12591 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12592 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12593 &*reduce*& expansion.
12595 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
12596 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
12597 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode
12598 or for cutthrough delivery,
12599 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
12602 .vitem &$version_number$&
12603 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12604 The version number of Exim.
12606 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12607 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12608 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12609 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12611 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12612 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12613 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12614 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12620 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12621 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12623 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12624 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12625 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12626 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12627 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12628 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12633 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12636 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12637 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12638 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12639 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12640 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12641 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12642 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12643 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12644 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12646 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12647 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12648 should usually be something like
12650 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12652 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12653 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12654 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12655 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12656 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12657 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12658 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12659 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12663 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12664 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12665 a startup when Exim is entered.
12667 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12668 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12671 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12672 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12675 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12676 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12677 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12678 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12682 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12683 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12685 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12686 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12687 with an error message of the form
12689 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12691 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12692 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12693 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12694 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12695 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12696 that was passed to &%die%&.
12699 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12700 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12701 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12704 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12706 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12707 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12708 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12710 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12711 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12712 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12713 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12715 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12716 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12717 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12718 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12719 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12720 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12721 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12724 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12725 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12726 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12727 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12728 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12729 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12730 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12731 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12732 avoided, but the output is lost.
12734 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12735 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12736 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12737 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12738 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12739 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12740 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12742 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12744 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12745 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12746 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12747 as the first subroutine argument.
12751 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12752 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12754 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12755 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12756 "Starting the daemon"
12757 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12758 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12759 .cindex "network interface"
12760 .cindex "interface" "network"
12761 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12762 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12763 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12764 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12765 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12766 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12767 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12768 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12769 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12770 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12771 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12774 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12775 and ports to listen on.
12777 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12778 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12779 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12780 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12781 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12782 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12783 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12784 as an error situation.
12786 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12787 for the outgoing connection.
12791 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12792 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12793 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12794 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12795 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12797 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12798 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12799 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12800 chapter describes how they operate.
12802 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12803 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12807 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12808 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12809 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12813 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
12815 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12817 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12818 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12821 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12822 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12823 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12824 colons. For example:
12826 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12829 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12831 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12832 in &%local_interfaces%&:
12835 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12836 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12838 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12839 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12842 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12843 with a colon separator, for example:
12845 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12846 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12850 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12851 default setting contains just one port:
12853 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12855 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12856 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12857 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12858 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12859 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12863 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12864 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12865 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12866 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12867 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12868 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12870 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12872 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12874 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12876 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
12880 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
12881 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
12882 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
12883 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
12884 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
12885 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
12888 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
12889 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
12890 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
12891 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
12892 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12893 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
12897 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
12900 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
12902 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12903 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12904 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12908 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12909 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12910 .cindex "smtps protocol"
12911 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12912 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12913 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12914 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12915 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12916 list of port numbers or service names,
12917 connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12918 common use of this option is expected to be
12920 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12922 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12923 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12924 this way when a daemon is started.
12926 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12927 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12928 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12929 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12930 connections via the daemon.)
12935 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12936 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12937 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12938 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12939 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12940 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12941 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12942 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12944 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12946 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12947 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12948 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12949 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12950 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12951 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12953 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12955 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12956 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12957 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12958 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12959 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12961 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12962 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12963 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12964 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12965 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12966 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12967 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12968 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12969 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12970 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12971 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12972 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12974 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12975 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12976 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12977 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12978 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12982 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12983 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12985 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12986 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12988 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12989 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12990 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12991 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12993 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12995 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12997 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12999 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13000 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13002 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13003 IPv4 loopback address only:
13005 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13007 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13009 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13011 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13015 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13016 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13017 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13018 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13021 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13022 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13023 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13024 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13026 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13027 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13028 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13029 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13030 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13031 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13032 used for listening. Consider this example:
13034 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13036 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13038 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13040 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13041 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13044 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13045 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13046 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13047 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13048 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13049 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13050 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13051 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13055 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13056 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13057 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13058 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13059 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13060 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13066 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13067 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13069 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13070 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13071 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13072 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13075 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13076 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13078 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13079 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13080 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13082 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13083 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13084 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13085 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13089 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13090 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13091 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13092 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13093 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13094 listed in more than one group.
13096 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13098 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13099 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13100 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13101 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13102 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13103 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13104 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13105 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13106 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13110 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13112 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13113 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13114 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13115 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13116 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13117 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13122 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13124 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13125 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13126 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13127 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13128 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13129 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13130 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13131 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13132 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13133 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13134 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13139 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13141 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13142 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13143 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13144 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13145 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13146 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13147 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13148 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13149 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13150 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13151 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13152 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13157 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13159 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13160 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13161 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13162 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13167 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13169 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13170 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13171 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13172 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13173 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13174 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13175 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13176 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13177 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13178 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13179 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13180 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13181 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13182 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13183 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13188 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13190 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13191 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13196 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13198 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13199 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13204 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13206 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13207 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13208 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13209 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13210 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13211 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13212 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13217 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13219 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13220 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13221 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13222 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13223 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13224 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13225 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13226 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13227 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13228 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13229 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13230 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13231 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13232 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13233 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13234 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13236 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13237 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13238 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13239 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13240 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13245 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13247 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13248 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13249 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13250 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13251 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13252 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13253 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13254 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13255 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13256 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13257 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13258 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13259 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13260 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13261 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13262 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13263 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13264 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13265 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13266 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13267 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13269 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13270 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13271 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13272 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13273 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13274 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13275 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13276 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13277 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13278 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13279 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13280 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13281 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13282 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13283 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13284 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13285 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13286 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13291 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13293 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13295 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13297 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13298 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13299 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13304 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13306 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13307 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13308 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13309 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13310 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13311 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13312 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13313 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13314 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13315 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13316 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13317 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13318 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13319 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13320 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13321 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13326 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13328 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13329 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13330 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13331 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13332 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13333 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13334 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13335 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13340 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13342 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13343 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13344 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13345 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13346 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13347 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13348 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13349 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13355 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13357 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13364 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13365 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13368 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13369 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13370 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13371 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13372 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13373 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13374 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13375 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13376 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13377 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13378 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13379 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13380 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13381 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13383 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13384 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13385 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13386 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13387 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13388 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13389 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13390 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13391 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13392 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13393 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13394 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13395 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13396 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13397 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13398 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13403 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13405 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13406 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13407 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13408 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13409 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13410 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13411 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13416 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13418 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13419 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13420 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13421 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13423 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13424 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13425 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13426 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13427 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13428 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13429 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13430 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13431 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13432 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13437 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13439 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13440 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13442 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13443 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13444 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13445 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13446 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13451 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13453 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13454 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13455 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13456 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13457 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13458 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13459 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13460 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13461 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13462 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13463 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13464 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13465 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13466 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13467 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13468 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13469 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13470 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13471 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13472 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13473 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13474 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13475 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13480 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13482 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13483 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13484 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13485 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13486 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13487 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13488 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13489 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13490 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13491 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13492 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13493 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13494 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13495 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13500 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13501 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13504 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13506 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13507 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13508 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13509 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13510 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13511 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13512 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13514 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13515 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13516 It now defaults to true.
13517 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13519 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13522 To log received 8BITMIME status use
13524 log_selector = +8bitmime
13527 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13528 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13529 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13530 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13531 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13534 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13535 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13536 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13539 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13540 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13541 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13542 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13543 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13545 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13546 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13547 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13548 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13549 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13551 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13552 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13553 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13554 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13556 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13557 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13558 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13559 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13560 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13562 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! unset
13563 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13564 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
13565 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
13566 This option defines the ACL that,
13567 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
13568 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
13569 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
13570 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13572 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13573 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13574 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13575 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13577 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13578 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13579 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13580 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13582 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13583 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13584 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13585 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13586 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13589 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13590 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13591 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13592 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13594 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13595 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13596 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13597 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13598 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13600 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13601 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13602 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13603 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13604 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13606 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13607 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13608 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13611 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13612 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13613 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13614 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13616 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13617 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13618 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13619 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13621 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13622 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13623 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13624 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13626 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13627 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13628 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13629 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13631 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13632 .cindex "admin user"
13633 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13634 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13635 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13636 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13637 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13638 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13639 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13641 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13642 .cindex "domain literal"
13643 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13644 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13645 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13646 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13648 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13649 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13650 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13651 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13652 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13653 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13654 the local host's IP addresses.
13657 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13658 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13659 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13660 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13661 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13662 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
13663 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13664 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13665 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13667 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13668 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13669 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13670 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13671 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13672 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13673 experiment if they wish.
13675 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13676 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13677 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13678 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13679 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13680 suitable setting is:
13682 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13683 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13685 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13687 dns_check_names_pattern =
13689 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13692 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13693 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13694 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13695 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13696 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13697 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13698 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13699 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13700 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13701 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13702 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13704 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13705 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13706 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13707 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13708 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13709 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13711 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13712 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13713 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13714 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13716 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13718 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13719 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13720 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13721 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13724 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13725 .cindex "thawing messages"
13726 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13727 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13728 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13729 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13730 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13731 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13733 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13734 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13735 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13738 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13739 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13740 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13742 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13744 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13745 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13748 .option bi_command main string unset
13750 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13751 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13752 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13753 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13756 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13757 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13758 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13759 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13760 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13761 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13764 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13765 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13766 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13767 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13769 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13770 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13771 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13772 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13773 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13774 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13775 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13776 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13777 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13778 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13780 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13781 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13782 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13783 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13786 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13787 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13788 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13789 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13790 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13791 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13792 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13793 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13794 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13796 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13797 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13798 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13799 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13800 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13803 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13804 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13805 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13806 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13807 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13808 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13809 connection. A typical setting might be:
13811 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13813 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13815 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13817 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13820 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
13821 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
13822 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
13823 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
13824 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13825 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13828 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
13829 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
13830 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13831 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13834 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
13835 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
13836 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13837 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13840 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
13841 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
13842 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13843 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13846 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
13847 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
13848 callout verification. The default value is
13850 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
13852 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
13855 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
13856 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13859 .option check_log_space main integer 0
13860 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13862 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
13863 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
13864 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
13865 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
13866 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
13867 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
13868 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
13869 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
13870 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
13871 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
13874 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
13875 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13878 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
13879 .cindex "checking disk space"
13880 .cindex "disk space, checking"
13881 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
13882 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
13883 message is accepted.
13885 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13886 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13887 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13888 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13889 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
13890 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
13891 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
13892 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
13895 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
13896 either value is greater than zero, for example:
13898 check_spool_space = 10M
13899 check_spool_inodes = 100
13901 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
13902 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
13905 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
13906 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
13907 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
13909 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
13910 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
13911 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
13912 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
13913 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
13914 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
13916 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
13917 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
13919 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
13920 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
13921 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
13923 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
13924 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
13925 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13926 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
13927 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
13928 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
13930 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
13931 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
13932 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
13933 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
13934 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
13935 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
13936 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
13938 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
13939 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13941 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13942 .cindex "warning of delay"
13943 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13944 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13945 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13946 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13947 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13948 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13949 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13952 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13954 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13955 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13956 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13957 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13961 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13962 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13964 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13966 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
13967 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
13968 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
13970 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13971 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13972 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13973 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13974 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13975 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13976 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13977 not sent. The default is:
13979 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13980 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13981 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13982 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13985 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13986 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13987 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13988 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13990 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13991 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13992 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13993 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13994 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13995 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13996 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13997 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13999 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14000 .cindex "load average"
14001 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14002 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14003 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14004 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14005 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14008 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14009 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14010 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14011 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14012 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14013 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14014 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14015 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14017 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14018 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14019 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14020 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14021 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14022 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14023 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14024 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14026 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14027 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14028 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14029 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14032 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14033 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14034 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14035 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14036 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14037 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14038 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14041 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14042 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14043 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14044 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14045 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14046 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14047 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14048 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14049 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14050 by a setting such as this:
14052 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14054 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14055 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14056 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14057 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14058 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14059 options are applied after this global option.
14061 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14062 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14063 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14064 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14065 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14066 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14067 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14068 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14069 value of this option. The default pattern is
14071 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14072 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14074 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14075 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14076 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14077 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14078 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14081 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14082 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14083 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14085 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14086 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14087 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14088 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14091 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14092 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14093 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14094 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14095 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14096 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14098 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14101 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14102 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14103 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14104 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14105 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14106 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14107 domain matches this list.
14109 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14110 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14111 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14114 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14115 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14116 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14117 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14118 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14119 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14120 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14121 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14122 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14123 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14127 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14128 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14131 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14132 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14133 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14134 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14135 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14136 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14139 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14142 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14143 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14144 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14145 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14147 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14148 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14149 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14150 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14151 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14152 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14154 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14156 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14157 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14159 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14160 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14161 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14162 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14163 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14164 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14165 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14166 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14167 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14170 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14171 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14172 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14173 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14174 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14175 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14176 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14177 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14178 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14180 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14181 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14182 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14183 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14184 are examined. For example:
14186 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14187 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14188 postmaster@mydomain.example
14190 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14191 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14192 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14193 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14194 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14195 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14196 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14199 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14200 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14201 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14203 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14205 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14206 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14207 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14208 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14209 overrides the default.
14211 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14212 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14213 and warning messages. For example:
14215 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14217 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14218 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14219 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14220 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14224 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14225 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14226 .cindex "Exim group"
14227 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14228 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14229 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14230 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14231 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14235 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14236 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14237 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14238 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14239 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14240 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14242 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14243 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14244 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14245 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14248 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14249 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14250 .cindex "Exim user"
14251 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14252 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14253 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14254 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14256 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14257 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14258 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14259 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14262 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14263 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14264 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14265 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14268 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14269 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14271 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
14272 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14274 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14275 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14276 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14277 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14278 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14279 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14280 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14281 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14282 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14283 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14287 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14288 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14289 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14290 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14291 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14292 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14293 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14294 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14297 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14298 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14299 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14300 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14304 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14305 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14306 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14307 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14308 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14309 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14310 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14311 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14312 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14313 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14314 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14315 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14316 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14317 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14318 logging that you require.
14321 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14323 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14324 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14325 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14326 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14327 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14328 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14329 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14330 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14332 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14333 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14334 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14337 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14338 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14339 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14340 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14342 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14346 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14347 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14350 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14351 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14352 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14353 implementations of TLS.
14356 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14357 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14358 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14361 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14366 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
14367 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14368 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14369 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14370 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14371 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14375 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14376 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14377 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14378 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14379 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14380 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14381 sections are rejected.
14384 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14385 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14386 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14387 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14388 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14389 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14390 zero means &"no limit"&.
14395 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14396 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14397 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14398 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14399 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14400 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14401 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14402 if you want to do semantic checking.
14403 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14407 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14408 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14409 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14410 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14411 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14412 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14413 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14415 helo_allow_chars = _
14417 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14420 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14421 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14422 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14423 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14424 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14425 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14426 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14430 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14431 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14432 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14433 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14434 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14435 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14436 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14437 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14438 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14439 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14440 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14441 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14443 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14444 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14445 EHLO command either:
14448 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14450 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14451 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14452 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14453 calling host address, or
14455 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
14456 available) yields the calling host address.
14459 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14460 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14461 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14463 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14464 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14465 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14466 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14467 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14468 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14469 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14470 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14471 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14474 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14475 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14476 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14477 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14478 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14479 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14480 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14481 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14482 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14484 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14485 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14486 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14487 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14488 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14490 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14491 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14492 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14493 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14496 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14497 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14498 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14499 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14500 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14501 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14502 default configuration file contains
14506 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14507 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14509 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14510 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14511 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14513 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14514 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14515 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14516 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14517 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14518 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14521 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14522 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14523 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14524 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14525 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14528 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14529 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14530 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14531 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14535 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14536 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14537 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14538 as soon as the connection is made.
14539 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14540 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14541 connections immediately.
14543 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14544 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14545 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14546 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14547 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14550 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14551 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14552 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14553 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14554 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14555 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14556 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14557 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14558 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14560 hosts_connection_nolog = :
14562 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14566 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14567 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14568 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
14569 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14570 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14572 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14573 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14575 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14576 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14577 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14578 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14579 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14580 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14581 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14584 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14585 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14586 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14587 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14588 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14592 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14593 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14594 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
14595 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14596 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14597 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14599 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14600 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14601 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14602 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14603 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14604 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14605 for frozen messages. For example,
14607 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14609 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14610 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14611 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14612 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14613 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14614 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14617 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14618 .cindex "&""From""& line"
14619 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14620 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14621 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14622 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14623 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14624 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14625 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14626 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14629 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14630 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14633 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
14634 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14635 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14636 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14640 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14641 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14642 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14643 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14644 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14645 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14646 and constrained to be a directory.
14649 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14650 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14651 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14652 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14653 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14654 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14655 and constrained to be a file.
14658 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14659 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14660 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14661 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14662 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14665 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14666 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14667 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14668 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14669 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14670 identity to be proven.
14673 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14674 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14675 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14676 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14677 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14680 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14681 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14682 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14683 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14684 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14688 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14689 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14690 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14691 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14692 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14693 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14697 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14698 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14699 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14700 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14701 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14703 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14704 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14707 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14708 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14709 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14710 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14711 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14712 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14713 has been built with LDAP support.
14717 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14718 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14719 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14720 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14721 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14722 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14723 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14725 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14726 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14727 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14729 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14730 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14731 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14732 and the default qualify domain.
14734 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14735 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14736 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14737 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14739 .cindex "envelope sender"
14740 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14741 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14742 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14744 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14745 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14746 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14751 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
14752 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14753 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14754 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14755 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14756 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14757 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14760 local_from_prefix = *-
14762 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
14764 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
14766 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
14767 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
14771 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
14772 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
14775 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
14776 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
14777 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
14778 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
14779 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
14780 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
14781 &%local_interfaces%& is
14783 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14785 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
14787 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14790 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
14791 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
14792 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
14793 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
14794 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
14795 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
14796 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
14797 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
14801 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
14802 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
14803 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14804 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
14805 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
14806 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
14807 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
14808 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14813 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
14814 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
14815 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
14816 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
14817 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
14818 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
14819 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
14820 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
14821 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
14822 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
14823 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
14824 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
14825 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
14826 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
14827 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
14831 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
14832 .cindex "log" "file path for"
14833 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
14834 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
14835 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
14836 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
14837 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
14838 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
14839 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
14840 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
14841 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
14842 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
14843 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
14844 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
14847 .option log_selector main string unset
14848 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14849 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
14850 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
14851 minus characters. For example:
14853 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
14855 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
14856 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
14859 .option log_timezone main boolean false
14860 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
14861 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14862 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14863 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
14864 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
14865 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
14866 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
14867 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
14868 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
14869 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
14870 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
14871 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
14874 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
14875 .cindex "too many open files"
14876 .cindex "open files, too many"
14877 .cindex "file" "too many open"
14878 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
14879 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
14880 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
14881 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
14882 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
14883 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
14884 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
14885 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
14886 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
14887 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
14888 &%lookup_open_max%&.
14891 .option max_username_length main integer 0
14892 .cindex "length of login name"
14893 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
14894 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
14895 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
14896 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
14897 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
14898 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
14901 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
14902 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
14903 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
14904 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14905 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14906 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
14907 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
14908 option is set true, this no longer happens.
14911 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
14912 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
14913 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
14914 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14915 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14916 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
14917 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
14920 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
14921 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
14922 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
14923 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
14924 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
14925 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
14926 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
14927 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
14928 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
14929 empty string, the option is ignored.
14932 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
14933 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
14934 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
14935 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
14936 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
14937 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
14938 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
14939 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
14940 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
14941 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
14942 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
14943 colons will become hyphens.
14946 .option message_logs main boolean true
14947 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
14948 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
14949 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
14950 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
14951 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
14952 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
14953 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
14954 which is not affected by this option.
14957 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
14958 .cindex "message" "size limit"
14959 .cindex "limit" "message size"
14960 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
14961 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
14962 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
14963 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
14964 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
14965 optionally followed by K or M.
14967 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
14968 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
14969 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
14970 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
14971 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14973 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
14974 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
14975 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
14976 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
14977 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
14978 message that an individual transport can process.
14980 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
14981 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
14982 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
14983 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
14984 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
14985 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
14986 some problems may result.
14988 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
14989 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
14990 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
14993 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
14994 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
14995 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
14997 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
14999 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15000 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15001 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15002 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15003 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15006 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15007 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15008 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15009 contains a full description of this facility.
15013 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15014 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15015 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15016 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15017 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15020 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15021 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15022 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15023 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15024 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15027 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15028 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15029 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15030 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15031 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15033 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15034 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15037 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15039 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15040 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15044 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
15045 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15046 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15047 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15048 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15050 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15051 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15052 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15053 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15054 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15055 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15056 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15058 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15059 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15060 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15061 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15062 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15064 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15065 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15066 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15067 some now infamous attacks.
15071 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15072 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15073 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15076 Possible options may include:
15080 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15082 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15084 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15088 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15090 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15092 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15094 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15096 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15098 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15102 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15116 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15120 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15122 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15124 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15126 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15130 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15133 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15134 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15135 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15136 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15137 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15138 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15141 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15142 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15143 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15144 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15145 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15148 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15149 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15150 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15151 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15152 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15153 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15154 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15155 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15156 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15157 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15160 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15161 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15162 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15163 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15164 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15165 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15166 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15169 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15170 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15171 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15174 .option perl_startup main string unset
15175 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15176 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15179 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15180 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15181 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15182 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15183 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15184 PostgreSQL support.
15187 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15188 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15189 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15190 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15191 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15194 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15196 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15198 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15199 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15200 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15203 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15204 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15205 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15206 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15207 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15208 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15209 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15210 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15211 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15214 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15215 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15216 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15217 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15218 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15219 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15220 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15221 is recieved. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15223 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15224 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15225 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15226 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15227 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15228 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15229 volume of mail. Use with care!
15232 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15233 .cindex "name" "of local host"
15234 .cindex "host" "name of local"
15235 .cindex "local host" "name of"
15236 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15237 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15238 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15239 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15240 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15241 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15243 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15244 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15245 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15246 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15247 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15248 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15251 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15252 .cindex "printing characters"
15253 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15254 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
15255 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15256 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15257 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15258 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15261 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15262 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15263 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15264 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15265 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15269 .option process_log_path main string unset
15270 .cindex "process log path"
15271 .cindex "log" "process log"
15272 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15273 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15274 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15275 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15276 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15277 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15278 different spool directories.
15281 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15285 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15286 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15287 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15290 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15291 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15292 .cindex "address" "qualification"
15293 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15294 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15295 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15296 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15297 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15298 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15300 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15301 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15302 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15303 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15304 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15305 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15306 &%primary_hostname%& value.
15309 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15310 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15311 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15315 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15316 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15317 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15318 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15319 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15320 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15321 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15322 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15325 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15327 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15328 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15329 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15332 .option queue_only main boolean false
15333 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15334 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15335 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15336 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15337 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15338 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15340 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15341 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15342 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15343 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15346 .option queue_only_file main string unset
15347 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15348 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15349 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15350 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15351 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15352 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15353 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15354 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15356 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15358 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15359 &_/some/file_& exists.
15362 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15363 .cindex "load average"
15364 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15365 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15366 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15367 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15368 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15369 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15370 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15373 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15374 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15375 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15376 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15379 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15380 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15381 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15382 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15383 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15384 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15385 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15386 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15387 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15388 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15389 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15390 re-evaluated for each message.
15393 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
15394 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15395 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15396 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15397 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15398 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15401 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15402 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15403 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15404 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15405 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15406 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15407 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15408 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15409 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15410 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15411 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15412 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15413 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15417 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
15418 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15419 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15420 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15421 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15422 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15423 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15424 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15425 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15427 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15428 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15429 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15430 the daemon's command line.
15432 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15433 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15434 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15435 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15436 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15437 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15438 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15439 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15440 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15441 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15442 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15443 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15444 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15448 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
15449 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15450 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15451 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15452 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15453 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15454 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15456 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15457 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15458 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15459 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15460 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15461 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15462 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15463 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15464 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15465 header lines. The default setting is:
15468 received_header_text = Received: \
15469 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15470 {${if def:sender_ident \
15471 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15472 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15473 by $primary_hostname \
15474 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15475 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15476 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15477 ${if def:sender_address \
15478 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15479 id $message_exim_id\
15480 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15483 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15484 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15485 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15486 header lines such as the following:
15488 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15489 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15490 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15491 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15492 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15493 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15494 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15496 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15497 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15498 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15499 message was accepted.
15502 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
15503 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
15504 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
15505 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15506 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15507 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15508 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15509 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15512 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15513 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15514 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15515 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15516 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15517 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15518 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15519 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15520 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15521 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15522 option was not set.
15525 .option recipients_max main integer 0
15526 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15527 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15528 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15529 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15530 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15531 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15532 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15535 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15536 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15537 RCPT commands in a single message.
15540 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15541 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15542 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15543 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15544 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15545 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15546 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15549 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15550 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15551 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15552 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15553 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15554 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15555 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15556 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15557 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15558 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15559 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15560 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15561 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15562 tagged with its process id.
15564 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15565 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15566 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15567 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15570 .cindex "number of deliveries"
15571 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15572 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15573 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15574 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15575 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15576 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15577 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15578 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15579 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15580 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
15582 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15583 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15584 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15585 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15588 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15589 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15590 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15591 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15592 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15594 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15596 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15597 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15600 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15601 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15602 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15603 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15604 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15608 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15609 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15610 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15611 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15612 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15613 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15614 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15618 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
15619 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15620 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15621 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15622 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15623 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15624 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15625 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15626 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15627 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15630 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15631 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15634 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15636 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15637 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
15640 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
15641 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15642 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15643 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15644 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15647 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15648 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15649 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15650 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15651 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15652 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15653 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15654 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15655 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15656 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15659 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15660 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15661 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15662 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15663 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15664 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15665 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15666 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15667 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15668 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15669 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15673 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15674 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15675 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15677 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15678 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15679 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15680 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15681 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15682 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15684 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15685 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15686 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15687 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15690 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15691 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15692 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15693 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15694 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15695 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15696 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15697 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15699 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15700 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15701 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15702 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15703 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15704 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15705 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15706 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15709 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15710 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15711 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15712 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15716 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15717 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15718 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
15719 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
15720 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
15721 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
15722 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
15723 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
15724 . the option name to split.
15726 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15727 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15728 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15729 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15730 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15731 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15732 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15733 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15734 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15738 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
15739 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
15740 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
15741 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
15742 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
15743 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
15744 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
15745 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
15746 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
15747 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
15748 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
15750 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
15751 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
15752 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
15753 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
15754 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
15755 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
15759 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
15760 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15761 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15762 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
15763 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
15764 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
15765 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
15766 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
15767 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
15768 to all messages received in the same connection.
15770 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
15771 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
15772 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
15773 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
15776 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15778 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
15779 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
15780 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15781 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
15782 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
15783 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
15784 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
15785 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
15786 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
15787 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
15788 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
15789 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
15790 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
15793 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
15794 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
15795 .cindex "host" "reserved"
15796 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
15797 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
15798 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
15799 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
15800 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
15801 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
15802 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
15803 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
15806 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
15807 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
15808 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
15809 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
15812 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
15813 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
15814 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
15815 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15816 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
15817 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
15818 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
15819 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
15820 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
15822 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
15823 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
15824 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
15825 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
15827 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
15828 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
15829 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
15830 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
15831 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
15834 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
15835 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
15838 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
15839 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
15840 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
15841 &%helo_data%& value.
15843 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
15844 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
15845 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
15846 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
15847 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
15848 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
15849 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
15851 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
15852 $version_number $tod_full
15854 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
15855 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
15856 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
15857 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
15858 multiline response).
15861 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
15862 .cindex "checking disk space"
15863 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15864 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15865 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
15866 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
15867 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
15868 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
15869 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
15872 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
15873 .cindex "connection backlog"
15874 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
15875 .cindex "backlog of connections"
15876 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
15877 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
15878 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
15879 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
15880 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
15881 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
15882 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
15883 attacks by SYN flooding.
15886 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
15887 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
15888 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
15889 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
15890 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
15891 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
15892 fewer, but they still exist.
15894 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
15895 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
15896 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
15897 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
15898 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
15899 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
15900 does detect many instances.
15902 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
15903 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
15904 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
15905 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
15909 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
15910 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
15911 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15912 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
15913 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
15914 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
15915 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
15916 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
15919 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
15920 $sender_host_address
15922 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
15923 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
15924 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
15925 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
15926 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
15930 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
15931 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
15932 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
15933 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
15934 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
15937 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
15938 .cindex "load average"
15939 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
15940 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
15941 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
15942 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
15943 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
15944 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
15948 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
15949 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
15950 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
15951 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
15952 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
15954 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
15956 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
15957 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
15958 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
15959 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
15960 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
15962 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
15963 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
15964 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
15965 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
15966 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
15967 not count towards the limit.
15971 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
15972 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
15973 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
15974 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
15975 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
15978 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
15979 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
15983 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15984 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
15985 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
15986 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
15987 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
15988 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
15991 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
15992 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
15993 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
15994 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
15996 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
15997 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
15998 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
15999 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16003 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16005 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16006 fractional parts are allowed here.
16008 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16010 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16011 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16014 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16015 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16017 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16018 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16020 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16021 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16022 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16023 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16026 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16027 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16030 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16031 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16034 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
16035 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16036 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16037 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16038 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16039 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16040 the message is abandoned.
16041 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16043 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16044 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16046 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16047 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16051 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16052 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16053 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16054 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16055 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16058 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16059 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16060 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16063 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16064 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16065 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16066 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16067 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16068 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16069 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16070 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16071 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16072 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16074 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16075 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16078 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
16079 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16080 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16081 The default value is
16085 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16089 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16090 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16091 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16092 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16093 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16094 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16095 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16096 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16097 arrival of the message.
16099 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16100 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16101 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16102 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16103 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16105 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16106 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16107 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16108 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16109 automatically deleted.
16111 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16112 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16113 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16114 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16115 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16116 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16117 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16118 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16119 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16122 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16123 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16124 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16125 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16126 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16127 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16128 &$primary_hostname$&.
16130 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16131 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16132 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16133 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16134 as failures in the configuration file.
16136 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16137 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16139 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16140 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16141 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16142 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16144 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16145 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16146 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16147 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16148 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16149 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16151 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16152 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16153 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16154 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16155 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16156 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16157 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16160 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16161 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16162 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16163 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16164 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16165 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16166 domain causes a syntax error.
16167 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16171 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16172 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16173 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16174 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16175 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16176 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16177 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16178 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16179 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16180 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16181 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16182 the LOG_ALERT priority.
16185 .option syslog_facility main string unset
16186 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16187 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16188 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16189 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16190 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16191 details of Exim's logging.
16195 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16196 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16197 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16198 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16199 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16203 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16204 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16205 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16206 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16207 details of Exim's logging.
16210 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
16211 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
16212 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16213 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16214 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16215 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16216 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16217 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16218 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16219 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16220 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16223 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16224 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
16225 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16226 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16227 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16228 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16231 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16232 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16233 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16234 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16235 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16237 .option system_filter_group main string unset
16238 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16239 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
16240 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
16241 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
16243 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
16244 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
16245 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
16246 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
16247 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
16248 contains the pipe command.
16251 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
16252 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
16253 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
16254 is used in a system filter.
16257 .option system_filter_user main string unset
16258 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
16259 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
16260 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
16261 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
16262 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
16263 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
16264 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
16265 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
16266 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
16268 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
16269 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
16270 transport option overrides.
16273 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
16274 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
16275 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
16276 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
16277 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
16278 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
16279 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16280 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16281 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16282 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16283 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16284 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
16288 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
16289 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
16290 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
16291 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
16292 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
16293 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16294 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16295 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16296 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16297 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16299 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16300 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16301 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16304 .option timezone main string unset
16305 .cindex "timezone, setting"
16306 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16307 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16308 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16309 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16313 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16314 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16315 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16316 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16317 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16318 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16321 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16322 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16323 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16324 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16325 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16326 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16327 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16328 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16331 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16332 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16333 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16334 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16335 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16336 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16337 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16339 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16340 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16341 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16342 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16344 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16345 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16346 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16347 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16349 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16350 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16351 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16352 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16353 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16355 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16358 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16359 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16360 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16361 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16362 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16363 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16365 The value must be at least 1024.
16367 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16368 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16369 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16371 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16374 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16375 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16376 larger prime than requested.
16379 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16380 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16381 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16382 to be used by Exim.
16384 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16385 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16386 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16387 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16388 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16389 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16390 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16392 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16395 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16396 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16397 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16398 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16400 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16401 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
16402 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16403 in IKE is assigned number 23.
16405 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16406 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16407 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16410 The available primes are:
16411 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16412 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16413 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16415 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16416 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16418 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16419 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16420 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16421 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16422 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16425 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16426 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16427 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16428 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16429 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16430 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16431 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16434 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
16436 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
16437 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
16438 Certificate Authority.
16441 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16442 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16443 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16444 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16445 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16449 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16450 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16451 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16452 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16453 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16454 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16455 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16457 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16460 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16461 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16462 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16463 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16464 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16465 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16469 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16470 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16471 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16472 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16473 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16474 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16475 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16476 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16477 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16478 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16479 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16482 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16483 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16484 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16485 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16488 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
16489 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16490 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16491 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
16492 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
16493 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
16494 are using either GnuTLS version 3.3.6 (or later) or OpenSSL,
16495 you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
16496 directory containing certificate files.
16497 For earlier versions of GnuTLS
16498 the option must be set to the name of a single file.
16500 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16501 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16502 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16503 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16504 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16505 use OpenSSL with a directory.
16507 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16509 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
16513 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16514 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16515 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16516 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16517 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16518 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16519 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16520 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16522 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16523 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16524 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16525 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16526 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16527 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16528 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16530 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16531 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16532 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16533 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16534 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16535 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16536 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16539 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16543 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16544 .cindex "trusted groups"
16545 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
16546 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16547 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16548 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16549 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16550 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16551 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16554 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16555 .cindex "trusted users"
16556 .cindex "user" "trusted"
16557 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16558 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16559 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16560 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16561 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16562 Exim user are trusted.
16564 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16565 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16566 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16567 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16568 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16569 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16570 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16571 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16572 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16575 .option unknown_username main string unset
16576 See &%unknown_login%&.
16578 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16579 .cindex "trusted users"
16580 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16581 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16582 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16583 .cindex "envelope sender"
16584 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16585 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16586 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16587 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16588 is used) is ignored.
16590 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16591 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16593 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16595 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16596 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16597 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16598 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16599 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16600 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16601 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16602 followed by a hyphen
16603 by a setting like this:
16605 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16607 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16608 restriction, you can use
16610 untrusted_set_sender = *
16612 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16613 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16614 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16615 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16616 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16617 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16618 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16619 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16621 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16622 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16623 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16624 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16628 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16629 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16630 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16631 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16632 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16633 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16634 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16635 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16636 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16637 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16639 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16640 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16642 The pattern can be seen by running
16644 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16646 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16647 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16648 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16649 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16650 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16651 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16654 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16655 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16658 .option warn_message_file main string unset
16659 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16660 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16661 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16662 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16663 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16664 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16665 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16668 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16669 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16670 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16671 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16672 .ecindex IIDconfima
16673 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
16678 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16679 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16681 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16682 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16683 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16684 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16685 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
16687 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16688 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16689 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16690 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16691 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16695 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
16696 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
16697 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
16698 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
16699 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
16700 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
16701 delivery of the address to be deferred.
16703 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16704 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
16705 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
16706 routers, and the eventual transport.
16708 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
16709 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
16710 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
16711 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
16712 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
16714 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
16715 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
16716 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
16717 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
16718 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
16720 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
16721 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
16722 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
16724 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
16726 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
16728 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
16730 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
16731 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
16733 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
16734 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16735 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
16736 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
16737 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
16738 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
16739 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
16743 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
16745 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
16746 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
16747 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
16748 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
16749 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
16754 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
16755 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
16756 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
16757 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
16758 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
16759 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
16760 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
16761 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
16762 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
16763 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
16766 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
16768 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
16771 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
16773 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
16774 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
16775 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
16776 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
16779 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
16780 .cindex "case of local parts"
16781 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
16782 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
16783 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
16784 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
16785 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
16786 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
16787 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
16790 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16791 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
16792 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
16793 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
16794 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
16795 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
16796 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
16797 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
16798 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
16800 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
16801 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
16802 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
16803 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
16807 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
16808 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
16809 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
16810 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
16812 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
16813 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
16814 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
16815 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
16816 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
16817 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
16818 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
16819 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
16820 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
16821 the router is skipped.
16823 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
16824 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
16825 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
16826 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
16827 setting to achieve this. For example:
16829 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
16831 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
16832 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
16833 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
16837 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
16838 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
16839 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
16840 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
16841 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
16842 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
16843 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
16844 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
16846 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
16847 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
16849 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
16850 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
16852 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
16853 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
16854 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
16856 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16858 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
16860 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
16863 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
16865 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16866 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
16870 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
16871 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
16872 be specified using &%condition%&.
16875 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
16876 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
16877 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
16878 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
16879 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
16880 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
16881 Router rules processing behavior.
16883 This is best illustrated in an example:
16885 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
16886 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
16888 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
16891 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
16894 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
16895 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
16896 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
16897 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
16898 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
16899 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
16900 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
16901 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
16903 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
16904 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
16905 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
16906 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
16909 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
16910 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
16911 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
16912 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
16913 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
16917 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
16918 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
16919 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
16920 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
16921 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
16922 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
16923 output, and Exim carries on processing.
16924 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
16925 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
16926 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
16927 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
16928 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
16929 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
16930 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
16934 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
16935 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
16936 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
16937 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
16938 transport option of the same name.
16941 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
16942 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
16943 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
16944 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
16945 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
16946 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
16947 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
16948 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
16952 .option driver routers string unset
16953 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
16958 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
16959 .cindex "envelope sender"
16960 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
16961 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
16962 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
16963 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
16964 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
16965 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
16966 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
16968 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
16969 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
16970 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
16973 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
16974 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
16975 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
16976 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
16978 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
16979 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
16980 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
16981 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
16987 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
16988 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
16989 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
16990 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
16991 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
16993 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16994 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
16995 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
16996 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
16997 setting &%return_path%&.
16999 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17000 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17001 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17005 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17006 .cindex "address" "testing"
17007 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17008 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17009 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17010 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17011 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17012 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17013 on for the system alias file.
17014 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17017 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17018 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17019 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17023 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17024 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17025 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17026 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17030 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17031 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17032 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17036 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17037 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17038 verifying a sender, verification fails.
17042 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17043 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17044 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17045 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17046 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17047 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17048 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17049 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17050 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17052 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17053 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17054 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17055 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17056 transport for further details.
17059 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
17060 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17061 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17062 .cindex "transport" "local"
17063 .cindex "router" "setting group"
17064 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17065 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17067 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17068 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17069 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17070 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17071 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17075 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17076 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
17077 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17078 This option specifies a list of text headers, newline-separated,
17079 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17080 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17081 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17082 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17083 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17084 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17085 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17086 &"see"& the added header lines.
17088 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17089 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17090 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17091 failures are treated as configuration errors.
17093 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17094 for a router; all listed headers are added.
17096 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17097 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17099 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17100 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
17101 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17102 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17103 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17104 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17105 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17106 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17107 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17108 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17112 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17113 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
17114 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17115 This option specifies a list of text headers, colon-separated,
17116 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17117 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17118 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17119 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17120 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17121 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17122 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17123 &"see"& the original header lines.
17125 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17126 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17127 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17130 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17131 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17133 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17134 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17136 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17137 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17138 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17139 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17142 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17143 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17144 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17145 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17146 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
17147 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
17148 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
17151 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
17155 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
17157 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
17158 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
17159 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
17160 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
17161 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
17162 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
17164 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
17165 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
17167 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
17168 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
17170 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
17171 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
17173 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
17174 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17175 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
17176 domain that is being routed.
17178 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17179 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
17182 .option initgroups routers boolean false
17183 .cindex "additional groups"
17184 .cindex "groups" "additional"
17185 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17186 .cindex "transport" "local"
17187 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
17188 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
17189 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
17190 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
17191 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17195 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
17196 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
17197 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
17198 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
17199 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
17200 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
17203 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
17204 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
17205 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
17206 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
17207 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
17208 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
17209 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
17210 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
17211 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
17213 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17214 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
17215 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
17216 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
17217 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
17218 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
17219 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
17220 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
17221 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
17222 the relevant transport.
17224 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
17225 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
17226 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
17229 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
17230 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
17231 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
17232 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
17233 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
17237 local_part_prefix = real-
17239 transport = local_delivery
17241 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
17242 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
17244 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
17245 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
17248 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
17249 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
17250 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
17251 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
17254 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
17255 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
17259 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
17260 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
17261 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
17262 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
17263 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
17264 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
17265 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
17266 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
17267 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
17271 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
17272 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
17276 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
17277 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
17278 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
17279 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
17280 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17282 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
17283 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
17286 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
17288 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
17289 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
17290 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
17291 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
17292 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
17293 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
17294 each virtual domain:
17298 local_parts = postmaster
17299 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
17303 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
17304 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
17305 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
17306 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
17307 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
17308 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
17309 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
17310 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
17311 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
17312 redirect addresses.
17316 .option more routers boolean&!! true
17317 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17318 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17319 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17320 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
17321 delivery to be deferred.
17323 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
17324 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
17326 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
17327 means of the setting
17331 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
17332 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
17333 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
17335 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
17336 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
17337 controls what happens next.
17340 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
17341 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
17342 .cindex "router" "timeout"
17343 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
17344 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17345 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17346 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17347 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17349 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17350 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17351 applies to all of them.
17355 .option pass_router routers string unset
17356 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17357 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17358 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17359 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17360 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17361 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17362 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17363 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17364 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17365 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17369 .option redirect_router routers string unset
17370 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17371 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17372 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17373 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17374 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17376 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17377 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17378 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17379 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17383 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17384 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17385 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17386 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17387 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17388 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17389 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17391 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17392 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17393 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17394 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17396 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17397 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17398 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17399 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17400 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17403 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17404 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17407 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17408 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17409 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17410 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17411 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17412 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17413 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17414 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17416 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17417 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17418 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17419 operates as follows:
17421 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17422 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17423 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17424 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17427 require_files = mail:/some/file
17428 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17430 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17431 &%require_files%& condition fails.
17433 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17434 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17435 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17436 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17438 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17439 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17440 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17441 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17442 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
17444 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
17445 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
17446 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
17447 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
17448 check again in that process.
17450 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
17451 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
17452 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
17453 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
17454 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
17455 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
17456 as if the file did not exist. For example:
17458 require_files = +/some/file
17460 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
17461 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
17462 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
17466 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
17467 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
17468 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
17469 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
17470 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
17471 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
17472 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
17473 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
17476 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
17477 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
17478 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
17479 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
17480 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
17483 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
17484 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
17485 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
17489 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
17490 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
17491 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
17493 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
17494 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
17495 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
17496 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
17497 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
17498 cause the router to defer.
17500 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
17501 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
17503 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17505 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
17506 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
17508 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
17509 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
17510 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
17511 of these values that is set:
17514 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
17516 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
17518 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
17520 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
17523 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
17524 router, but not for the transport.
17528 .option self routers string freeze
17529 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17530 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17531 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
17532 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
17533 and &(manualroute)& routers.
17534 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
17536 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
17537 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
17538 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
17539 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
17540 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17542 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
17543 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
17544 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
17545 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
17546 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
17551 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
17553 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
17554 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
17555 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
17556 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
17558 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17559 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17560 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17565 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17566 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17567 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17568 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17569 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17570 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17576 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17577 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17578 be passed to the next router.
17581 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17584 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
17585 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17586 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17587 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17588 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17589 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17594 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17595 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
17596 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17597 address matches something on the list.
17598 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17601 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17602 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17603 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17604 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17605 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17606 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17607 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17611 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17612 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
17613 .cindex "packet radio"
17614 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17615 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17616 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17617 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17618 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17619 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17620 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17621 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17623 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17624 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17625 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17626 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17627 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17628 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17629 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17630 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17631 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17632 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17634 translate_ip_address = \
17635 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17638 The file would contain lines like
17640 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
17641 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17643 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17648 .option transport routers string&!! unset
17649 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
17650 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
17651 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
17652 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
17653 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
17654 delivery is deferred.
17656 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
17657 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
17658 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
17662 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
17663 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
17664 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
17665 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
17666 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
17667 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
17668 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
17669 overridden by a setting on the transport.
17670 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17671 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17672 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
17678 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
17679 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
17680 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
17681 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
17682 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
17683 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
17684 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
17685 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
17686 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17687 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17689 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
17690 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
17691 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
17692 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
17693 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
17695 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
17701 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
17702 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
17703 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17704 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17705 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17706 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
17707 delivery to be deferred.
17709 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
17710 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
17711 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
17712 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
17713 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
17714 sometimes true and sometimes false).
17716 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
17717 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
17718 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
17719 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
17720 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
17721 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
17722 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
17723 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
17725 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
17726 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
17727 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
17728 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
17729 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
17730 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
17731 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
17732 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
17733 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
17734 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17736 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
17737 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
17738 subsequent routers.
17741 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
17742 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
17743 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17744 .cindex "transport" "local"
17745 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
17746 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
17747 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17748 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
17749 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17750 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17751 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
17752 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
17753 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
17754 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
17755 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
17756 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17760 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
17761 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
17762 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17765 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
17766 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
17768 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
17769 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
17770 delivering in cutthrough mode or
17771 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
17772 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
17773 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
17774 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
17776 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
17777 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
17778 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
17782 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
17783 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
17785 delivering in cutthrough mode
17786 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
17787 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17789 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
17792 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
17793 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
17794 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
17795 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17797 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
17798 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
17799 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
17806 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17807 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17809 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
17810 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
17811 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
17812 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
17813 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
17814 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
17815 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
17816 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
17817 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
17821 domains = mydomain.example
17823 transport = local_delivery
17825 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
17826 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
17827 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
17828 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
17835 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17836 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17838 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
17839 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
17840 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
17841 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
17842 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
17843 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
17845 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
17846 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
17847 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
17848 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
17851 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
17852 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
17853 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
17854 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
17855 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17856 generic option, the router declines.
17858 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
17859 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
17860 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
17862 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17863 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17864 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
17865 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
17866 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
17867 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
17870 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
17871 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
17872 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
17873 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
17874 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
17875 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
17877 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
17878 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
17879 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
17880 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
17881 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
17882 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
17883 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
17884 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
17885 case routing fails.
17888 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
17889 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
17890 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
17891 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
17892 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
17894 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
17896 The domain does not exist in DNS
17898 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
17899 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
17900 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
17902 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
17904 MX record points to a non-existent host.
17906 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
17907 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
17909 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
17910 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
17912 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
17913 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
17915 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
17916 not be found in the MX records (see below)
17922 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
17923 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
17924 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
17926 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
17927 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
17928 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
17929 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
17930 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
17931 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
17932 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17935 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
17936 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
17937 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
17938 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
17939 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
17940 required. For example,
17944 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
17945 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
17946 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
17947 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
17948 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
17951 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
17952 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
17953 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
17954 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
17955 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
17956 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
17958 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
17959 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
17960 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
17961 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
17962 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
17963 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
17964 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
17965 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
17967 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
17968 when there is a DNS lookup error.
17972 .option dnssec_request_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17973 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17974 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17975 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17976 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17977 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17978 the dnssec request bit set.
17979 This applies to all of the SRV, MX A6, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17983 .option dnssec_require_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17984 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17985 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17986 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17987 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17988 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17989 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17990 (AD bit) set wil be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17991 This applies to all of the SRV, MX A6, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17995 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17996 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
17997 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
17998 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
17999 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18000 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18001 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18004 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18006 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18007 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18008 the address record.
18011 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18012 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18013 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18014 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18019 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18020 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18021 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18022 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18023 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18024 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18025 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18026 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18027 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18032 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18033 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18034 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18035 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18036 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18037 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18038 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18039 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18040 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18041 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18042 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18044 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18045 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18048 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18049 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18050 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18051 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18052 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18056 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18057 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18058 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18059 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18060 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18061 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18062 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18063 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18065 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18066 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18067 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18068 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18069 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18070 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18071 without processing them independently,
18072 provided the following conditions are met:
18075 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18076 &%headers_remove%&.
18078 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18085 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18086 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18087 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18088 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18089 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18090 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18091 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18092 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18093 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18094 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18096 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18097 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18102 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18103 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18104 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18105 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18110 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18111 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18112 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18113 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18116 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18118 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18119 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18120 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18121 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18122 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18123 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18126 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18127 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18128 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18129 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18130 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18132 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18133 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18134 such as that implied by
18138 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18139 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18140 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18141 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18151 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18152 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18154 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
18155 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
18156 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
18157 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
18158 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
18159 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
18160 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
18161 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
18162 router handles the address
18166 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
18167 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
18168 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
18170 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
18172 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
18173 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
18175 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
18176 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
18177 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
18178 &%self%& option determines what happens.
18180 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
18181 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
18182 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
18183 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
18187 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18188 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18190 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
18191 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
18192 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
18193 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
18194 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
18195 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
18198 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
18200 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
18202 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
18203 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
18204 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
18205 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
18206 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
18207 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
18208 must not be specified for it.
18210 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
18211 .option hosts iplookup string unset
18212 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
18213 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
18214 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
18215 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
18216 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
18219 .option optional iplookup boolean false
18220 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
18221 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
18222 delivery to the address is deferred.
18225 .option port iplookup integer 0
18226 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
18227 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
18231 .option protocol iplookup string udp
18232 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
18233 protocols is to be used.
18236 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
18237 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
18240 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
18242 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
18243 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
18246 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
18247 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
18248 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
18249 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
18250 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
18251 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
18252 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
18253 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
18256 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
18257 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
18258 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
18259 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
18260 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
18261 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
18262 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
18263 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
18264 following could be used:
18266 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
18267 reroute = $local_part@$1
18270 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
18271 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
18272 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
18273 call. It does not apply to UDP.
18278 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18279 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18281 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
18282 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
18283 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
18284 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
18285 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
18286 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
18287 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
18288 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
18289 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
18290 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
18292 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
18293 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
18294 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
18295 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
18296 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
18297 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
18298 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
18301 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
18302 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
18303 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
18304 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
18305 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
18306 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
18307 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
18310 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
18311 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
18312 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
18313 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
18314 below, following the list of private options.
18317 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
18319 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
18320 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
18322 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
18323 See &%host_find_failed%&.
18325 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
18326 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
18327 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
18328 of the following values:
18337 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
18338 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
18339 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
18342 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
18343 router only if &%more%& is true.
18345 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
18346 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
18347 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
18348 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
18350 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
18351 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18352 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18355 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18356 .cindex "randomized host list"
18357 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18358 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18359 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18360 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18361 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18362 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18363 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18364 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18366 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18367 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18368 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18369 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18371 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18373 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18374 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18375 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18376 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18377 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18380 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18381 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18382 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18385 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18387 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18388 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18392 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18393 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18394 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18395 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18398 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18399 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18400 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18401 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18402 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18403 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18404 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18405 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18407 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18408 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18409 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18410 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18411 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18412 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18413 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18414 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18419 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18420 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18421 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18422 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18423 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18424 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18426 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18428 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18432 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18433 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18435 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18436 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18437 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18438 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18439 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18440 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18441 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18442 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18443 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18444 in a &%route_list%&).
18446 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18447 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18448 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18449 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18453 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
18454 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
18455 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
18456 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
18457 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
18458 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
18459 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
18462 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
18463 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18465 This data can be accessed by setting
18467 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
18469 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
18470 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
18471 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
18472 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
18473 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
18478 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
18479 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
18480 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
18481 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
18482 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
18483 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
18484 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18486 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
18487 variables are set during its expansion:
18490 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18491 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
18492 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
18494 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
18497 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
18499 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
18502 .vindex "&$value$&"
18503 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
18504 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
18506 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
18510 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
18511 semicolon is the default route list separator.
18515 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
18516 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
18517 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
18518 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
18519 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
18520 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
18523 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
18524 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
18525 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
18527 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
18528 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
18531 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
18532 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
18533 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
18534 number follows. For example:
18536 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
18540 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
18541 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
18542 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
18543 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
18544 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
18547 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
18548 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
18549 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
18550 records in the DNS. For example:
18552 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
18554 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
18557 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
18559 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
18560 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
18561 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
18562 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
18563 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
18564 happens is controlled by the
18565 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18566 &%self%& option of the router.
18568 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
18569 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
18570 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
18571 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
18572 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
18573 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
18574 defined by MX preferences.
18576 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
18577 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
18578 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
18580 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
18581 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
18582 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
18583 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
18585 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18586 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18589 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18590 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18591 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18593 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18594 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18598 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18599 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18600 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18601 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18602 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18603 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18604 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18607 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18608 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18610 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18611 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18613 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18614 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18615 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18617 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18618 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18619 timeout), delivery is deferred.
18624 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18625 domain2 host4:host5
18627 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18628 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18629 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18630 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18633 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
18634 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
18635 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
18636 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18641 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18642 &%host_find_failed%& option.
18645 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18646 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18650 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18651 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18652 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18655 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
18656 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
18657 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
18658 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
18660 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
18662 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
18663 your first router something like this:
18666 driver = manualroute
18667 domains = !+local_domains
18668 transport = remote_smtp
18669 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
18671 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
18672 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
18673 they are tried in order
18674 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
18675 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
18678 driver = manualroute
18679 transport = remote_smtp
18680 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
18682 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
18683 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
18684 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
18685 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
18686 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
18687 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
18688 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
18689 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
18692 .cindex "mail hub example"
18693 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
18694 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
18695 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
18696 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
18697 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
18698 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
18699 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
18700 lookup is easier to manage.
18702 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
18703 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
18707 driver = manualroute
18708 transport = remote_smtp
18709 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
18711 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
18712 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
18713 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
18714 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
18715 domain can be used to find the host:
18718 driver = manualroute
18719 transport = remote_smtp
18720 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
18722 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
18723 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
18724 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
18728 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
18729 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
18730 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
18731 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
18732 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
18733 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
18736 driver = manualroute
18737 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
18738 route_list = saved.domain.example
18740 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
18741 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
18742 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
18745 driver = manualroute
18747 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
18748 *.saved.domain2.example \
18749 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
18752 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18754 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
18755 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
18756 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
18757 the address if the lookup fails.
18760 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
18761 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
18762 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
18763 one way it can be done:
18769 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
18770 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
18771 return_fail_output = true
18776 driver = manualroute
18778 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
18780 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
18782 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
18784 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
18785 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
18786 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
18788 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
18789 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
18798 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18799 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18801 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
18802 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
18803 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
18804 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
18805 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
18806 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
18807 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
18808 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
18809 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
18810 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
18812 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
18814 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
18815 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
18816 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
18817 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
18818 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
18821 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
18822 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
18823 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
18824 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
18825 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
18826 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
18829 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
18830 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
18831 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
18832 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
18833 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
18834 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
18835 not set, a value for the gid also.
18837 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
18838 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
18839 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
18840 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
18841 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
18842 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
18846 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
18847 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
18848 before running the command.
18851 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
18852 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
18853 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
18857 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
18858 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
18859 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
18860 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
18861 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
18864 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
18867 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
18868 &%no_more%& is set.
18870 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
18871 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
18872 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
18873 included in the SMTP response.
18875 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
18876 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
18877 included in any SMTP response.
18879 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
18881 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
18882 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
18884 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
18885 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
18886 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
18889 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
18890 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
18893 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
18894 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
18896 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
18897 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
18898 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
18899 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
18901 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
18902 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
18903 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
18904 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
18905 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
18907 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
18908 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
18909 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
18910 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
18911 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
18913 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18914 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
18915 variable. For example, this return line
18917 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
18919 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
18920 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
18921 .ecindex IIDquerou1
18922 .ecindex IIDquerou2
18927 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18928 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18930 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
18931 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
18932 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
18933 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
18934 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
18935 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
18936 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
18937 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
18938 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
18939 redirected in several different ways:
18942 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
18945 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
18947 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
18949 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
18951 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
18953 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
18955 It can be discarded.
18958 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
18959 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
18960 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
18961 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
18965 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
18966 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
18967 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
18968 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
18969 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
18970 aliases, in a configuration like this:
18974 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
18976 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
18977 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
18978 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
18979 cause delivery to be deferred.
18981 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
18982 &_.forward_& files, like this:
18987 file = $home/.forward
18990 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
18991 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
18992 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
18993 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
18998 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
18999 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19000 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19001 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19004 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19005 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19006 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19007 practice the router may not be able to operate.
19009 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19010 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19011 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19012 saves some resources.
19020 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19021 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19022 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19023 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19024 can be interpreted in two different ways:
19027 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19028 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19029 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19030 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19031 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19032 document is intended for use by end users.
19034 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19035 described in the next section.
19038 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19039 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19040 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19041 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19042 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19046 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19047 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19048 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19049 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19050 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19051 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19052 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19053 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19054 commas or newlines.
19055 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19058 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19059 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19060 next newline character is ignored.
19062 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19063 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19064 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19065 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19068 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19069 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19070 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19071 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19072 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19073 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19076 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19080 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19081 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
19082 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19083 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19084 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19085 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19086 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19087 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19088 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19089 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19090 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19092 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19093 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19094 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19095 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19096 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19098 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19100 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
19101 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19102 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19103 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19104 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19107 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
19108 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19109 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19110 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19111 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19113 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19114 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19119 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19120 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19123 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19125 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19126 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19127 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19128 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19129 should really contain
19131 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19133 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19134 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19135 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19139 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19140 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19141 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19144 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19145 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
19146 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
19147 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
19148 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
19149 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19150 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19152 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
19153 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
19154 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
19155 in double quotes, for example:
19157 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
19159 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
19160 quote just the command. An item such as
19162 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
19164 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
19166 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
19167 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
19168 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
19169 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
19170 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
19171 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
19172 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
19173 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
19174 an &%accept%& router.
19177 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
19178 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
19179 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
19180 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
19182 /home/world/minbari
19184 is treated as a file name, but
19186 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
19188 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
19189 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
19190 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
19191 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
19193 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19194 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19196 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
19197 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
19198 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
19199 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
19202 .cindex "included address list"
19203 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
19204 If an item is of the form
19206 :include:<path name>
19208 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
19209 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
19210 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
19211 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
19212 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
19213 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
19215 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
19217 It must be given as
19219 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
19222 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
19223 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
19224 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
19225 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
19226 .cindex "black hole"
19227 .cindex "abandoning mail"
19228 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
19229 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
19230 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
19232 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
19233 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
19234 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
19235 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
19239 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
19240 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
19241 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
19242 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
19243 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
19244 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
19245 redirection items of the form
19250 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
19251 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
19252 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
19253 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
19255 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
19257 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
19259 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
19260 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
19262 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
19263 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
19264 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
19266 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19267 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
19268 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
19269 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
19270 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
19271 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
19272 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
19273 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
19274 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
19277 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
19278 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
19279 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
19280 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
19282 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
19283 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
19284 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
19285 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
19286 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
19288 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
19289 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
19290 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
19291 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
19292 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
19296 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
19297 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
19298 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
19299 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
19300 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
19301 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
19302 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
19306 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
19307 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19308 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
19309 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
19310 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
19311 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
19312 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
19313 aliasing scheme of the type
19315 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
19319 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
19320 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
19321 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
19324 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
19325 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
19327 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
19328 the pipes are distinct.
19332 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
19333 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
19334 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
19335 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
19336 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
19337 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
19338 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
19339 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
19340 can be used to avoid this.
19343 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
19344 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
19345 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
19346 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
19347 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
19348 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
19349 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19353 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19355 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19356 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19359 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19360 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19361 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19364 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19365 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19366 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19367 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19370 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19371 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19372 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19373 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19374 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19375 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19376 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19378 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19379 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19382 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19383 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19384 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19385 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19386 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
19390 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
19391 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19392 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19393 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19394 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19395 let ordinary users do.
19399 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19400 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19401 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19402 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19403 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19404 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19406 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19407 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19408 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19409 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19410 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19411 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19413 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19415 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19416 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19417 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19418 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19419 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19420 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19421 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19422 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19425 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19426 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19427 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19428 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19429 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19430 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19431 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19432 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19436 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19437 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19438 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19439 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19440 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19441 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19444 .option data redirect string&!! unset
19445 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
19446 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
19447 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
19448 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
19449 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
19451 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
19452 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
19453 terminated with newline characters. For example:
19455 data = #Exim filter\n\
19456 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
19458 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
19459 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
19460 choice into a newline.
19463 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
19464 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
19465 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19466 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19467 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
19470 .option file redirect string&!! unset
19471 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
19472 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
19473 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
19474 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
19475 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
19476 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
19477 entirely of comments), the router declines.
19479 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
19480 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
19481 runs a check on the containing directory,
19482 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
19483 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
19484 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
19485 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
19486 not, the router declines.
19489 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
19490 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19491 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
19492 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19493 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19494 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
19495 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
19498 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
19499 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
19500 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
19501 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
19502 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
19505 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
19506 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
19510 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
19511 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
19512 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19517 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
19518 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
19519 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
19520 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
19521 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
19522 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
19523 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
19524 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
19525 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
19528 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
19529 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
19530 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19531 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
19534 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
19535 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
19536 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19537 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
19539 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
19540 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
19541 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
19542 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
19543 &_.forward_& files).
19546 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
19547 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19548 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
19551 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
19552 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
19553 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
19554 of the embedded Perl support.
19557 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
19558 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19559 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
19562 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
19563 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19564 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
19567 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
19568 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
19569 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
19570 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
19571 &%one_time%& is set.
19574 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
19575 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19576 to make use of &%run%& items.
19579 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
19580 If this option is true, items of the form
19582 :include:<path name>
19584 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19587 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19588 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19589 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19590 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19591 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19594 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19595 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19596 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19599 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19600 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19601 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19602 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19603 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19608 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19609 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19610 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19611 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19612 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19613 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19614 bounce may well quote the generated address.
19617 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19619 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19620 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19621 file did not exist.
19624 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19626 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19627 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19628 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
19630 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
19631 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
19632 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
19633 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
19634 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
19635 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
19636 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
19637 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19641 .option include_directory redirect string unset
19642 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19643 redirection list must start with this directory.
19646 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
19647 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
19648 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
19651 .option one_time redirect boolean false
19652 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
19653 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
19654 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
19655 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
19656 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
19657 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
19658 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
19659 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
19660 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
19661 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
19662 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
19663 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
19664 before they subscribed.
19666 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
19667 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
19668 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
19669 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
19672 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
19673 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
19674 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
19675 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
19677 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
19678 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
19679 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
19681 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
19684 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
19685 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
19686 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
19687 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
19688 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
19692 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
19693 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
19694 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
19695 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
19696 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
19697 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
19698 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
19699 See &%check_owner%& above.
19702 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
19703 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
19704 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
19705 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
19708 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
19709 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
19710 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
19711 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
19712 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
19713 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
19714 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
19717 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
19718 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
19719 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
19720 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
19721 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
19722 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
19723 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
19724 &$qualify_recipient$&.
19726 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
19727 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
19728 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
19731 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
19732 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
19733 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
19734 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
19735 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
19736 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
19737 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
19738 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
19739 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
19740 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
19743 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
19744 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
19745 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
19746 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
19747 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
19748 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
19751 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
19752 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
19753 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
19754 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
19755 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
19756 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
19759 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
19760 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
19761 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
19762 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
19763 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
19766 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
19767 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
19768 :subaddress part of an address.
19770 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
19771 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
19772 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
19773 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
19776 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
19777 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
19778 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
19779 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
19780 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
19781 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
19782 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
19786 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
19787 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
19788 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
19789 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
19790 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
19791 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
19792 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
19793 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
19794 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
19795 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
19796 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
19797 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
19798 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
19799 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
19800 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
19801 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
19803 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
19804 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
19805 the following routers.
19807 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
19808 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
19809 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
19810 so it is passed to the following routers.
19812 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
19813 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
19814 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
19815 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
19817 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
19818 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
19819 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
19820 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
19826 file = $home/.forward
19827 file_transport = address_file
19828 pipe_transport = address_pipe
19829 reply_transport = address_reply
19832 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
19833 syntax_errors_text = \
19834 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
19835 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
19836 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
19837 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
19838 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
19839 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
19840 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
19841 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
19842 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
19843 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
19845 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
19846 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
19847 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
19852 local_part_prefix = real-
19853 transport = local_delivery
19855 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19856 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19858 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19859 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19863 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
19864 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19867 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
19868 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19869 .ecindex IIDredrou1
19870 .ecindex IIDredrou2
19877 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19878 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19880 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
19881 "Environment for local transports"
19882 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
19883 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
19884 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
19885 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
19886 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
19887 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
19888 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
19890 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
19891 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
19892 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
19893 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
19895 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
19896 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
19897 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
19898 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
19899 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
19903 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
19904 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
19905 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
19906 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
19907 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
19908 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
19909 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
19912 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
19913 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
19917 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
19919 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
19920 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
19921 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
19922 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
19927 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
19928 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19929 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
19930 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
19931 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
19932 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
19933 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
19934 group (set by the transport). For example:
19937 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
19941 transport = group_delivery
19944 # This transport overrides the group
19946 driver = appendfile
19947 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19950 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
19951 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
19952 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
19955 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
19956 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
19957 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
19958 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
19959 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
19960 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
19962 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
19963 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
19964 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
19965 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
19966 original gid is also used.
19968 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
19969 following that is set is used:
19972 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
19974 A &%group%& setting of the router;
19976 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
19977 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
19979 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
19981 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
19982 the uid is the creator's uid;
19984 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
19987 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
19988 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
19989 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
19990 The first of the following that is set is used:
19993 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
19995 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
19997 A &%user%& setting of the router;
19999 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20004 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20005 &%never_users%& list.
20011 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20012 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20013 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20014 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20015 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20016 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20017 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20018 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20019 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20020 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20023 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20025 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20027 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20029 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20032 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20035 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20037 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20041 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20042 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20043 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20047 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20048 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20049 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20050 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20051 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20052 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20053 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20054 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20055 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20056 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20057 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20058 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20059 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20060 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20068 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20069 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20071 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20072 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20073 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20074 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20075 The following generic options apply to all transports:
20078 .option body_only transports boolean false
20079 .cindex "transport" "body only"
20080 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20081 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20082 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20083 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20084 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20085 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20086 automatically suppress them.
20089 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20090 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20091 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20092 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20093 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20094 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20097 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
20098 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20099 deliveries by the transport or for any
20100 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20101 what you are doing.
20104 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20105 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20106 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20107 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20109 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20110 output, and Exim carries on processing.
20111 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
20112 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
20113 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
20114 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
20116 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
20117 transport and the router that called it.
20119 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
20120 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
20121 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
20122 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
20123 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
20124 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
20125 safely be resent to other recipients.
20128 .option driver transports string unset
20129 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
20130 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
20133 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
20134 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20135 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
20136 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
20137 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
20138 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
20139 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
20140 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
20141 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
20142 resent to other recipients.
20145 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
20146 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
20147 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
20148 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
20149 &%user%& (see below).
20152 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
20153 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
20154 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
20155 This option specifies a list of text headers, newline-separated,
20156 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
20157 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
20158 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
20159 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20160 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20161 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20163 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
20164 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
20167 .option headers_only transports boolean false
20168 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
20169 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
20170 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
20171 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
20172 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
20173 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
20174 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
20177 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
20178 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
20179 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
20180 This option specifies a list of header names, colon-separated;
20181 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
20182 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
20184 Each list item is separately expanded.
20185 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20186 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20187 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20189 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
20190 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
20194 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
20195 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
20196 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
20197 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
20198 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
20199 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
20200 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
20201 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
20204 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
20207 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
20208 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
20209 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
20210 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
20211 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
20212 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
20213 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
20214 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
20215 change envelope recipients at this time.
20218 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
20219 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
20221 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
20222 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
20223 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
20224 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
20225 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
20226 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
20227 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
20231 .option initgroups transports boolean false
20232 .cindex "additional groups"
20233 .cindex "groups" "additional"
20234 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
20235 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
20236 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
20237 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
20240 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
20241 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
20242 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
20243 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
20244 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
20245 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
20246 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
20247 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
20248 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
20249 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
20250 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
20251 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
20252 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
20257 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
20258 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
20259 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
20260 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
20261 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
20262 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
20263 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
20264 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
20267 local_part_prefix = *-
20269 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
20272 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
20274 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
20275 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
20276 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
20277 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
20278 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
20281 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
20282 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20283 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
20284 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
20285 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
20286 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
20287 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
20288 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
20289 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
20291 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
20292 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
20293 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
20294 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
20296 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
20297 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
20298 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
20301 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
20302 .cindex "envelope sender"
20303 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
20304 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
20305 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
20306 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
20307 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
20308 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
20309 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
20310 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
20311 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
20313 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
20314 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
20316 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
20317 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
20318 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
20319 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
20320 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
20321 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
20322 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
20324 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
20325 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
20326 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
20327 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
20328 &%errors_to%& in a router.
20332 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
20333 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
20334 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
20335 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
20336 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
20337 have easy access to it.
20339 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
20340 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
20341 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
20342 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
20343 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
20347 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
20348 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
20351 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
20352 .cindex "shadow transport"
20353 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
20354 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
20355 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
20357 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
20358 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
20359 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
20360 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
20361 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
20362 cause a log line to be written.
20364 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
20365 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
20366 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
20367 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
20368 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
20371 ST=<shadow transport name>
20373 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
20374 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
20375 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
20376 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
20377 headers that some sites insist on.
20380 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
20381 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20382 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20383 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
20384 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
20385 individual users or via a system filter.
20387 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
20388 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
20389 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
20390 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
20391 command must be specified as an absolute path.
20393 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20394 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20395 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20396 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20397 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20398 &(pipe)& transports.
20400 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20401 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
20402 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
20403 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
20404 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
20406 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
20407 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
20408 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
20409 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
20411 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
20412 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
20413 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
20414 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
20415 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
20416 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
20418 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
20419 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
20420 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
20421 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
20422 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
20423 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
20424 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
20425 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
20427 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20428 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
20429 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
20430 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
20431 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
20432 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
20433 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
20434 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
20435 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
20436 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
20439 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20440 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
20441 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
20442 which the message is being sent. For example:
20444 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
20445 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
20448 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
20449 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
20450 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
20452 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
20453 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
20454 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
20457 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
20459 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
20460 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
20461 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
20462 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
20463 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
20464 Exim tried to expand the first one.
20466 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
20467 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
20468 arguments. Consider this example:
20470 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20471 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20473 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
20474 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
20476 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20477 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20481 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
20482 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
20483 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
20484 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
20485 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
20486 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
20487 bounced from a transport filter.
20489 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
20490 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
20491 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
20494 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
20495 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
20496 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
20497 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
20498 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
20499 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
20500 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
20501 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
20502 becomes a temporary error.
20505 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
20506 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20507 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
20508 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
20509 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
20510 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
20511 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
20514 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
20515 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
20516 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
20518 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
20519 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
20520 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
20521 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
20523 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
20524 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
20525 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
20532 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20533 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20535 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
20537 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
20538 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
20539 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
20540 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
20541 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
20542 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
20543 copy of the message is delivered each time.
20545 .cindex "batched local delivery"
20546 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
20547 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
20548 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
20549 local transport, for example:
20552 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
20553 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
20554 recipients saves space.
20556 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
20557 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
20559 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
20560 to a scanner program or
20561 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
20565 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
20566 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
20567 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
20569 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
20570 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
20571 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
20572 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
20573 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
20574 to certain conditions:
20577 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20578 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
20579 batching is possible.
20581 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20582 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
20583 addresses with the same domain are batched.
20585 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
20586 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20587 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20588 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20589 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20592 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20593 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
20594 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
20598 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
20599 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
20600 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
20601 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
20602 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
20603 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
20604 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
20607 escape_string = ".."
20609 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
20610 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
20611 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
20613 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20614 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
20615 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
20616 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
20617 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
20618 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
20620 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
20621 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20622 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
20623 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
20624 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
20625 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
20626 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
20627 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
20628 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
20633 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20634 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20636 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
20637 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
20638 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
20639 .cindex "directory creation"
20640 .cindex "creating directories"
20641 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
20642 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
20643 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
20644 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
20645 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
20646 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
20647 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
20648 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
20649 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
20650 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
20652 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
20653 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
20654 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
20657 .cindex "quota" "system"
20658 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
20659 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
20660 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
20662 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
20663 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
20664 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
20665 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
20667 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
20668 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
20671 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
20672 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
20673 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
20674 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
20679 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
20680 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
20681 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
20682 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
20683 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
20685 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20686 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20687 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
20688 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
20689 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
20690 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
20691 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
20692 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
20693 operation. There are two cases:
20696 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
20697 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
20698 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
20699 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
20700 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
20701 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
20702 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
20704 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
20705 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
20706 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
20710 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
20711 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
20712 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
20713 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
20718 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
20720 require "fileinto";
20721 fileinto "folder23";
20723 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
20724 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
20725 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
20726 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
20727 way of handling this requirement:
20729 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
20730 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
20731 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
20733 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
20737 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
20738 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
20739 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
20741 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
20742 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
20743 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
20744 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
20745 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
20746 path to the transport.
20748 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
20749 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
20754 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
20755 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
20759 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
20760 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
20761 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
20762 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
20763 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
20764 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
20765 delivery is deferred.
20768 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
20769 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20770 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20771 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
20772 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
20773 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
20774 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
20775 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
20778 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
20779 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20780 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
20781 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
20785 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
20786 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20789 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
20790 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
20791 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
20792 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
20793 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
20796 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
20797 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
20798 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
20799 process is running.
20802 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
20803 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20804 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
20805 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
20806 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
20807 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
20808 contains is significant.
20810 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
20811 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
20812 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
20813 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
20814 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
20816 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
20817 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
20818 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
20819 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
20820 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
20821 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
20823 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20824 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
20825 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20826 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20828 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
20829 .cindex "directory creation"
20830 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
20831 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
20832 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
20834 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
20835 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
20836 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
20837 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
20838 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
20842 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
20843 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
20844 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
20845 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
20846 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
20849 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
20850 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
20851 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
20852 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
20853 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
20854 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
20855 &%file_must_exist%&.
20858 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
20859 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
20860 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
20861 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
20863 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
20864 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
20865 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
20866 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
20867 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
20870 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
20872 .vindex "&$inode$&"
20873 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
20874 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
20875 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
20877 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
20879 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
20880 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
20884 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
20885 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
20886 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
20889 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
20890 See &%check_string%& above.
20893 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
20894 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
20895 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
20896 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
20897 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
20898 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
20901 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20902 .cindex "locking files"
20903 .cindex "lock files"
20904 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
20905 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
20907 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
20908 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
20911 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20912 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
20915 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
20916 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
20917 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
20918 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
20919 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
20920 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
20924 .option file_format appendfile string unset
20925 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
20926 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
20927 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
20928 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
20929 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
20930 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
20931 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
20932 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
20935 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
20936 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
20938 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
20939 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
20940 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
20941 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
20942 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
20943 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
20944 delivery is deferred.
20947 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
20948 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
20949 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
20950 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
20953 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
20954 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20955 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
20956 .cindex "locking files"
20957 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
20958 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
20959 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
20960 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
20961 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
20962 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
20963 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
20964 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
20966 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
20967 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
20968 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
20969 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
20971 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
20972 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
20975 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
20977 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
20978 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
20979 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
20981 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
20982 local deliveries because of errors of the form
20984 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
20987 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
20988 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
20989 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
20990 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
20993 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
20994 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
20995 for details of locking.
20998 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
20999 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21000 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21003 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21004 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21005 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21008 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21009 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21010 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21011 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21012 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21015 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21016 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21017 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21018 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21019 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21020 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21021 external source that maintains the data.
21024 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21025 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21026 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21027 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21028 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21029 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21030 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21031 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21035 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21036 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21037 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21038 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21039 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21040 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21041 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21042 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21043 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21044 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21047 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21048 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21049 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21050 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21051 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21052 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21053 calculation. The default value is:
21055 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21057 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
21058 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
21060 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
21062 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
21064 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
21065 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
21066 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
21067 directly into that directory.
21070 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
21071 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
21072 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21075 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
21076 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
21077 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21080 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
21081 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21082 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
21083 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
21084 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
21085 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
21086 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
21087 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21089 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
21090 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
21091 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
21092 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
21093 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
21094 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
21095 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
21096 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
21097 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
21098 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
21101 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
21102 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
21103 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
21104 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
21105 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
21106 below for further details.
21109 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
21110 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21111 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21114 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
21115 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21116 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21119 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
21120 .cindex "locking files"
21121 .cindex "file" "locking"
21122 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
21123 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
21124 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21125 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
21126 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
21127 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
21128 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
21130 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
21131 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
21132 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
21139 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
21140 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
21141 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
21142 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
21143 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
21144 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
21145 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
21146 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
21148 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
21149 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
21150 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
21151 append messages to it.
21154 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21155 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21156 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21157 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21158 in which case it is:
21160 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
21161 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
21163 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21164 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21166 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21167 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21168 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21169 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
21174 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21175 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21177 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21178 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
21179 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
21180 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
21181 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
21182 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
21183 value, and this option is ignored.
21186 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
21187 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
21188 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
21189 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
21190 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
21193 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
21194 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
21195 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
21196 on users about incoming mail.
21199 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
21200 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
21201 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
21202 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
21203 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
21204 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
21205 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
21206 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
21207 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
21209 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
21210 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
21211 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
21213 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
21214 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
21215 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
21216 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
21217 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
21218 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
21220 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
21221 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
21222 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
21223 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
21226 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
21228 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
21229 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
21230 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
21231 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
21232 system quota failures.
21234 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
21235 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
21236 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
21237 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
21238 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
21239 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
21240 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
21241 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
21242 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
21243 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
21246 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
21247 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
21248 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
21249 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
21250 delivery directory.
21253 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
21254 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
21255 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
21256 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
21257 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
21261 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
21262 See &%quota%& above.
21265 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
21266 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
21267 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
21268 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
21269 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
21270 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
21271 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
21273 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
21274 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
21275 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
21276 the file length to the file name. For example:
21278 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
21279 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
21281 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
21282 number of lines in the message.
21284 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
21285 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
21286 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
21288 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
21291 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
21292 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
21293 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
21295 quota_warn_message = "\
21296 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
21297 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
21298 This message is automatically created \
21299 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
21300 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
21301 a warning threshold that is\n\
21302 set by the system administrator.\n"
21306 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
21307 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
21308 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
21309 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21310 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
21311 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
21312 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
21313 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
21314 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
21318 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
21320 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
21321 percent sign is ignored.
21323 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
21324 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
21325 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
21326 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
21327 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
21328 &'From:'& line, the default is:
21330 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
21332 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
21333 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
21336 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
21337 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
21341 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
21342 .cindex "envelope sender"
21343 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
21344 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
21345 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
21346 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
21347 for details of batch SMTP.
21350 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
21351 .cindex "carriage return"
21353 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21354 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21355 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
21356 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21358 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
21359 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
21360 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
21361 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
21362 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
21363 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21366 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21367 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
21368 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
21369 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
21370 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21371 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
21374 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
21375 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
21376 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
21377 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
21378 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
21380 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
21381 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
21382 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
21383 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
21385 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
21386 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
21387 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
21388 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
21389 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
21392 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21393 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21396 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21397 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21398 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21399 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21400 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21401 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
21402 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
21404 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21405 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
21406 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
21407 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
21410 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
21411 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
21412 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
21415 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21416 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21417 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
21418 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
21419 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
21420 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
21421 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
21422 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
21423 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
21425 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21426 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
21427 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
21428 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
21433 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
21434 .cindex "appending to a file"
21435 .cindex "file" "appending"
21436 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
21439 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
21443 .cindex "directory creation"
21444 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
21445 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
21446 &%directory_mode%& option.
21449 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
21450 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
21454 .cindex "file" "locking"
21455 .cindex "locking files"
21456 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21457 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
21458 reliably over NFS, as follows:
21461 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
21462 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
21463 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
21465 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
21467 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
21468 Unlink the hitching post name.
21470 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
21471 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
21472 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
21473 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
21475 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
21476 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
21477 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
21478 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
21479 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
21480 it before trying again.
21484 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
21485 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
21486 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
21489 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21490 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21491 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
21492 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
21493 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
21494 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
21495 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
21496 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
21497 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
21501 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
21502 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
21503 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
21504 delivery is deferred.
21507 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
21508 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
21509 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
21513 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
21514 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
21515 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
21518 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
21519 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
21520 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
21523 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
21524 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
21525 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
21526 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
21527 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
21528 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
21529 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
21530 that prevents link following.
21533 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
21534 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
21535 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
21536 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
21537 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
21540 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
21543 .cindex "file" "locking"
21544 .cindex "locking files"
21545 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
21546 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
21547 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
21548 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
21549 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
21551 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
21553 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
21554 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
21555 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
21557 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
21558 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
21559 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
21561 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
21562 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
21563 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
21564 delivery is deferred.
21566 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
21567 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
21568 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
21569 immediately. It retries up to
21571 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
21573 times (rounded up).
21576 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
21577 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
21580 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
21581 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
21582 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21583 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
21584 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
21585 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
21586 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21587 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21588 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21589 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21591 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21592 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21593 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
21594 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
21595 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
21596 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
21597 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
21599 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
21600 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
21601 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
21602 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
21605 .cindex "maildir format"
21606 .cindex "mailstore format"
21607 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
21608 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
21609 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
21610 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
21611 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
21613 .cindex "directory creation"
21614 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
21615 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
21616 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
21617 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
21618 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
21619 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
21624 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
21625 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
21626 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
21627 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
21628 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
21629 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
21630 &_new_& subdirectory.
21632 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
21633 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
21634 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
21635 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
21636 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
21637 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
21638 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
21640 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
21641 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
21642 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
21643 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
21644 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
21645 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
21646 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
21647 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
21649 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
21650 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
21651 folders. Consider this example:
21653 maildir_format = true
21654 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
21655 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
21656 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
21657 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
21659 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
21660 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
21661 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
21662 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
21663 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
21664 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
21666 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
21667 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
21668 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
21669 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
21670 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
21672 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
21673 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
21674 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
21676 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21677 .cindex "maildir++"
21678 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
21679 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
21680 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
21681 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
21682 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
21683 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
21684 amount of space used.
21686 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
21687 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
21688 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
21689 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
21690 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
21691 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
21696 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
21697 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
21698 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
21699 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
21700 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
21701 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
21704 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
21705 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
21706 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
21707 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
21708 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
21709 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
21710 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
21711 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
21712 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
21713 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
21714 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
21715 backwards compatibility).
21717 For one common implementation, you might set:
21719 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
21721 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
21723 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
21724 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
21725 &[stat()]& each message file.
21728 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
21729 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21730 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21731 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
21732 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
21733 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
21734 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
21735 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
21736 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
21738 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
21739 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
21740 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
21741 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
21742 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
21743 need to know the quota.
21745 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
21746 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
21748 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
21749 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
21750 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
21754 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
21755 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
21756 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
21757 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
21758 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
21759 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
21760 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
21761 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
21763 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
21764 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
21765 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
21766 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
21767 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
21768 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
21770 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
21771 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
21772 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
21773 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
21774 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
21775 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
21777 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
21778 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
21779 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
21780 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
21783 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
21784 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
21785 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
21786 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
21787 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
21789 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
21791 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
21792 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
21793 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
21794 .ecindex IIDapptra1
21795 .ecindex IIDapptra2
21802 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21803 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21805 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
21806 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
21807 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
21808 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
21809 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
21810 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
21811 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
21812 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
21814 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
21815 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
21816 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
21817 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
21818 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
21821 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
21822 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
21823 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
21824 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
21825 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
21827 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
21828 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
21829 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
21830 transport is run as a consequence of a
21832 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
21833 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
21834 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
21835 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
21836 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
21837 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
21839 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
21840 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
21841 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
21842 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
21844 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
21845 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
21846 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
21847 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
21848 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
21849 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
21850 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
21852 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
21853 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
21854 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
21855 the transport defers.
21856 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
21857 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
21859 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
21860 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
21861 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
21862 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
21864 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
21865 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
21866 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
21867 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
21868 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
21869 problems. They are just discarded.
21873 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
21874 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
21876 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
21877 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
21878 message when the message is specified by the transport.
21881 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
21882 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
21883 when the message is specified by the transport.
21886 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
21887 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
21888 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
21889 string comes first.
21892 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
21893 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
21894 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
21897 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
21898 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
21899 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
21902 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
21903 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
21904 specified by the transport.
21907 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
21908 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
21909 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
21910 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
21913 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
21914 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
21915 the message is specified by the transport.
21918 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
21919 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
21923 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
21924 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
21925 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
21926 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
21927 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
21931 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
21932 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
21933 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
21934 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
21936 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
21937 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
21938 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
21939 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
21940 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
21941 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
21942 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
21945 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
21946 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
21947 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
21948 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
21949 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
21951 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
21952 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
21953 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
21954 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
21955 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
21956 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
21959 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
21960 See &%once%& above.
21963 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
21964 See &%once%& above.
21965 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
21968 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
21969 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
21970 specified by the transport.
21973 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
21974 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
21975 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
21976 configuration option.
21979 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
21980 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
21981 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
21982 automatic responses. For example:
21984 subject = Re: $h_subject:
21986 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
21987 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
21988 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
21989 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
21994 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
21995 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
21996 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
21997 the text comes first.
22000 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
22001 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22002 when the message is specified by the transport.
22003 .ecindex IIDauttra1
22004 .ecindex IIDauttra2
22009 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22010 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22012 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22013 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22014 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22015 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22016 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22017 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22019 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22020 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22021 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22022 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22023 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22024 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22028 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22029 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22030 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22033 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22034 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22037 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22038 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22039 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22040 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22041 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22044 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
22045 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22046 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22047 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22048 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22049 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22052 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
22053 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22054 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
22055 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
22056 in its response to the LHLO command.
22058 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
22059 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
22060 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
22061 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
22064 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
22065 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
22066 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
22067 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
22072 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
22076 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
22077 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
22081 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22082 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22084 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
22085 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
22086 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
22087 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
22088 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
22089 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
22090 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
22091 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
22095 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22096 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
22097 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
22098 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
22099 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
22101 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22102 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
22103 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
22104 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
22105 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
22106 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
22107 that are routed to the transport.
22109 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22110 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
22111 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
22112 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
22113 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
22114 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
22115 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
22119 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
22120 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
22121 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
22123 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
22124 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
22125 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
22126 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
22127 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
22128 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
22129 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
22132 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
22133 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
22134 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
22135 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
22136 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
22141 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
22142 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
22143 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
22144 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
22145 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
22146 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
22147 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
22148 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
22149 &"local delivery failed"&.
22151 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
22152 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
22153 will be sent as normal.
22155 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
22156 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
22157 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
22158 apply in this case.
22160 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
22161 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
22162 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
22163 a non-existent command may be the problem.
22165 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
22166 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
22167 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
22168 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
22169 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
22170 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
22171 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
22176 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
22177 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
22178 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
22179 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
22180 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
22183 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
22184 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
22185 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
22186 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
22188 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
22189 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
22190 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
22191 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
22192 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
22194 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
22196 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
22197 arguments. You have to write
22199 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
22201 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
22202 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
22203 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
22204 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
22205 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
22206 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
22209 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
22212 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22213 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22214 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22215 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
22216 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
22217 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
22218 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
22219 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
22220 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
22221 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
22223 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
22224 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
22225 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
22226 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
22227 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
22228 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
22229 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
22230 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
22232 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
22233 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
22234 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
22235 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
22236 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
22237 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
22238 control what is done with it.
22240 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
22241 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
22242 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
22243 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
22244 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
22245 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
22246 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
22247 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
22248 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
22249 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
22250 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
22254 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
22255 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22256 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
22257 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
22258 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
22259 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
22262 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
22263 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
22264 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
22265 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
22266 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
22267 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
22268 &`LOGNAME `& see below
22269 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
22270 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
22271 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
22272 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
22273 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
22274 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
22275 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
22276 &`USER `& see below
22278 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
22279 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
22280 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
22281 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
22282 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
22283 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
22284 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
22287 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
22288 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
22289 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
22293 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
22294 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
22295 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
22296 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
22299 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
22300 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
22304 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
22305 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
22306 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22307 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
22308 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
22309 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
22310 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
22311 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
22312 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
22313 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
22314 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
22317 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
22319 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
22320 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
22321 &%use_shell%& is set.
22324 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
22325 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22328 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
22329 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22330 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22333 .option check_string pipe string unset
22334 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
22335 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
22336 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
22337 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
22338 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
22339 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
22340 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
22344 .option command pipe string&!! unset
22345 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
22346 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
22347 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
22348 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
22349 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
22350 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
22353 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
22354 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22355 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
22356 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
22357 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
22358 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22359 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
22362 .option escape_string pipe string unset
22363 See &%check_string%& above.
22366 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
22367 .cindex "exec failure"
22368 .cindex "failure of exec"
22369 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
22370 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
22371 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
22372 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
22373 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
22376 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
22377 .cindex "signal exit"
22378 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
22379 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
22380 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
22381 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
22384 .option force_command pipe boolean false
22385 .cindex "force command"
22386 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
22387 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
22388 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
22389 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
22390 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
22391 command. For example:
22393 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22397 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
22398 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
22399 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
22401 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
22402 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
22403 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
22404 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
22405 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
22406 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
22408 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
22409 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
22411 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
22412 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
22413 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
22414 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
22415 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
22418 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
22419 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
22420 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
22421 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
22422 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
22423 Only one of them may be set.
22427 .option log_output pipe boolean false
22428 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
22429 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
22430 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22434 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
22435 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
22436 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
22437 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
22438 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
22439 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
22440 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
22441 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
22444 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
22445 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22446 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
22449 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
22453 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
22454 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22455 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
22456 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
22457 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
22462 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22463 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22466 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
22467 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22468 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
22469 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
22473 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22474 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22477 .option path pipe string "see below"
22478 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
22479 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
22483 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
22484 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
22485 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
22488 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
22489 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
22490 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
22491 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
22492 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
22493 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
22494 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
22495 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
22496 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
22499 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
22500 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22501 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
22502 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
22503 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
22504 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
22505 accept the message is used.
22508 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
22509 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
22510 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
22511 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
22512 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
22513 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
22516 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
22517 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
22518 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
22519 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
22520 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
22521 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
22522 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22526 .option return_output pipe boolean false
22527 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
22528 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
22529 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
22530 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
22531 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
22532 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
22533 of them may be set.
22537 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
22538 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
22539 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
22540 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
22541 and &%return_output%& is not set,
22542 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
22543 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
22544 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
22545 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
22546 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
22547 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
22548 and 73, respectively.
22551 .option timeout pipe time 1h
22552 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
22553 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
22554 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
22555 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
22556 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
22557 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
22559 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
22560 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
22561 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
22562 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
22563 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
22564 delivery to be deferred.
22566 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
22567 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
22570 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
22571 .cindex "envelope sender"
22572 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
22573 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
22574 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
22575 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
22576 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
22578 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
22579 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
22580 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
22581 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
22582 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
22583 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
22587 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
22588 .cindex "carriage return"
22590 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22591 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22592 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
22593 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22595 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
22596 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
22597 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
22598 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
22599 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22602 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
22603 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22604 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
22605 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
22606 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
22607 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
22608 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
22609 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
22610 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
22615 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
22616 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
22617 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
22618 .cindex "external local delivery"
22619 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
22620 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
22621 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
22622 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
22623 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
22624 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
22625 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
22626 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
22627 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
22628 configuration for &%procmail%&:
22633 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
22637 check_string = "From "
22638 escape_string = ">From "
22647 transport = procmail_pipe
22649 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
22650 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
22651 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
22652 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
22653 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
22654 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
22656 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
22660 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
22661 use a shell to run pipe commands.
22664 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
22665 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
22668 local_delivery_cyrus:
22670 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
22671 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
22683 local_part_suffix = .*
22684 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
22686 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
22687 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
22689 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
22690 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
22693 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22694 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22696 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
22697 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
22698 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
22699 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
22700 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
22701 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
22702 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
22703 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
22706 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
22707 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
22711 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
22712 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
22713 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
22714 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
22715 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
22716 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
22717 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
22719 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
22720 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
22721 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
22722 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
22723 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
22724 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
22729 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
22730 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
22731 no further messages are sent over that connection.
22735 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
22737 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22738 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
22739 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
22740 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
22741 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
22742 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
22743 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
22744 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
22747 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
22748 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
22749 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
22750 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
22751 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
22752 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
22753 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
22754 are the values that were set when the message was received.
22755 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
22756 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
22757 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
22758 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
22759 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
22760 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
22762 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
22763 and will be removed in a future release.
22766 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
22767 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
22768 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
22771 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
22772 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
22773 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
22774 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
22775 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
22776 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
22777 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
22778 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
22780 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
22781 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
22782 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22783 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
22784 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
22785 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
22786 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
22787 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
22788 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
22791 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
22793 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
22794 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
22795 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
22796 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
22797 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
22800 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
22801 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
22802 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
22803 particular connection.
22805 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
22806 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
22807 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
22808 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
22810 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
22811 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
22812 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
22814 authenticated_sender = $local_part
22816 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
22817 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
22819 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
22820 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
22824 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
22825 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
22826 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
22827 authenticated as a client.
22830 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
22831 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
22832 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
22833 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
22836 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
22837 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
22838 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
22839 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
22840 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
22841 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
22842 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
22845 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
22846 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
22847 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
22848 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22849 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
22850 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
22851 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
22855 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
22856 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
22857 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
22858 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
22861 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
22862 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
22863 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
22866 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
22867 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
22868 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
22869 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
22870 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
22871 unhappy at this prospect, so...
22873 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
22874 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
22875 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
22876 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
22877 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
22878 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
22879 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
22880 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
22884 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
22885 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
22886 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
22887 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
22888 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
22891 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
22892 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
22893 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
22894 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
22898 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
22899 .cindex "MX record" "security"
22900 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
22901 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
22902 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
22903 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
22904 the dnssec request bit set.
22905 This applies to all of the SRV, MX A6, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
22909 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
22910 .cindex "MX record" "security"
22911 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
22912 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
22913 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
22914 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
22915 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
22916 (AD bit) set wil be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
22917 This applies to all of the SRV, MX A6, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
22921 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
22922 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
22923 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
22924 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
22925 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
22926 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
22927 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
22929 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
22930 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
22931 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
22932 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
22933 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
22936 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
22937 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22938 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
22939 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
22940 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
22941 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22942 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22943 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
22945 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
22946 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
22947 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
22948 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
22949 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
22950 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
22952 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
22953 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
22954 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
22955 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
22956 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
22958 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
22959 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
22960 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
22961 copy of the message is sent.
22963 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
22964 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
22965 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
22966 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
22970 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
22971 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
22972 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
22975 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
22976 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
22977 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
22978 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
22979 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
22980 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
22982 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
22983 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
22984 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
22985 implementations of TLS.
22987 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
22988 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
22989 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
22990 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
22991 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
22992 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
22993 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
22998 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
22999 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23000 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23001 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23002 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23003 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23004 interface address, you could use this:
23006 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23007 {$primary_hostname}}
23009 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23012 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23013 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23014 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23015 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23016 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23017 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23019 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23020 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23021 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23022 &%hosts_override%& is set.
23024 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23025 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23026 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23027 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23028 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23029 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23030 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23032 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23033 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23034 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23035 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23036 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
23037 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
23038 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
23041 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
23042 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
23045 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23046 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
23047 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
23048 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
23049 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23050 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
23051 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
23052 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
23053 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
23054 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
23057 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
23058 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23059 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
23060 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
23063 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23064 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23065 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23066 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23068 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
23069 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23070 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
23071 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
23072 to any host that matches this list.
23073 Note that the default is to not use TLS.
23076 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
23077 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23078 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
23079 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
23080 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
23081 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
23082 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
23083 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
23086 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
23087 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
23088 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
23093 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23094 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
23095 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23096 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
23097 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
23098 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
23099 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
23100 explanation of when this might be needed.
23103 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
23104 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
23105 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
23106 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
23107 &%fallback_hosts%&.
23110 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
23111 .cindex "randomized host list"
23112 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
23113 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
23114 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
23115 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
23116 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
23117 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
23118 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
23119 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
23121 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
23122 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
23123 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
23124 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
23126 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
23128 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
23129 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
23130 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
23132 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23133 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
23134 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
23135 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
23136 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
23137 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
23138 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
23139 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
23140 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23143 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
23144 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23145 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
23146 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23147 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23149 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23150 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23151 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
23152 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23153 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23155 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23156 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23157 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23158 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23159 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
23160 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
23162 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23163 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
23164 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23165 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
23166 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
23167 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
23168 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23170 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" unset
23171 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
23172 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23173 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
23174 for multi-recipient messages.
23176 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
23177 .cindex "bind IP address"
23178 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
23180 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23181 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
23182 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
23183 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
23184 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
23185 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
23186 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
23187 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
23190 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
23191 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
23192 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
23193 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
23194 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
23195 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
23197 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
23199 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
23200 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
23201 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
23202 interface to use if the host has more than one.
23205 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
23206 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
23207 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
23208 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
23209 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
23210 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
23211 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
23212 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
23213 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
23214 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
23218 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
23219 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23220 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
23221 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
23222 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
23224 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
23225 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
23226 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
23227 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
23228 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
23232 .option multi_domain smtp boolean true
23233 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23234 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
23235 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
23236 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
23237 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
23238 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
23239 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
23242 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
23243 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
23244 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
23245 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
23246 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
23247 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
23248 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
23249 variable that contains an outgoing port.
23251 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
23252 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
23253 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
23254 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
23259 .option protocol smtp string smtp
23260 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
23261 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
23262 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
23264 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
23265 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
23266 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
23267 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
23268 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
23270 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default vaule for the &%port%& option
23271 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
23272 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
23273 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
23276 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
23277 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
23278 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
23279 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
23280 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
23281 addresses is not affected.
23283 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
23284 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
23285 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
23286 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
23287 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
23291 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23292 .cindex "serializing connections"
23293 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
23294 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
23295 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
23296 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
23297 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
23298 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
23299 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
23301 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
23302 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
23303 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
23304 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
23305 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
23306 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
23308 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
23309 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
23310 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
23311 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
23312 are used for ETRN serialization.
23315 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
23316 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
23317 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
23318 .cindex "size" "of message"
23319 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23320 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23321 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
23322 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
23323 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
23324 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
23325 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
23326 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
23328 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
23329 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
23332 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
23333 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
23334 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
23336 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23337 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23338 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
23339 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
23340 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
23343 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
23344 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
23345 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
23346 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
23350 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
23351 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
23352 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
23353 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
23354 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
23357 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
23358 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
23359 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
23360 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
23361 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
23362 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
23365 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
23368 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
23369 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
23371 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23372 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23373 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
23374 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
23375 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23376 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
23377 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
23378 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23381 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
23382 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
23383 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
23385 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23386 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
23387 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
23388 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
23389 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23390 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
23391 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
23392 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
23393 ciphers is a preference order.
23397 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
23398 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
23399 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
23400 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
23401 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
23402 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
23403 certificate and private key for the session.
23405 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
23407 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
23413 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
23414 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
23415 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
23416 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
23417 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
23418 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
23419 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
23420 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
23421 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
23422 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
23426 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!! unset
23427 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23428 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23429 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
23430 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
23431 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23432 Note that unless the host is in this list
23433 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
23434 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is set.
23435 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
23436 certificate verification succeeds.
23439 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
23440 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23441 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23443 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23444 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
23445 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
23447 if you are using either GnuTLS version 3.3.6 (or later) or OpenSSL,
23449 &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
23451 For earlier versions of GnuTLS the option must be set to the name of a
23453 The values of &$host$& and
23454 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23455 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23457 For back-compatability,
23458 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
23459 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
23462 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!! unset
23463 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23464 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23465 This option gives a list of hosts for which. on encrypted connections,
23466 certificate verification must succeed.
23467 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23468 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
23469 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
23474 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
23476 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23477 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
23478 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
23479 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
23480 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
23483 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
23484 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
23485 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
23486 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
23489 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
23490 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
23491 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
23493 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
23494 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
23495 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
23496 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
23497 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
23499 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
23500 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
23501 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
23502 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
23503 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
23504 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
23505 see below for an exception).
23507 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
23508 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
23509 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
23510 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
23511 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
23513 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
23514 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
23515 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
23516 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
23517 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
23518 reached their retry times.
23520 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
23521 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
23522 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
23523 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
23524 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
23525 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
23526 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
23527 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
23528 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
23529 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
23532 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
23533 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
23534 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
23535 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
23536 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
23537 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
23539 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
23540 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
23541 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
23542 possible IP addresses have been tried.
23543 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
23544 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
23550 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23551 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23553 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
23554 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
23555 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
23556 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
23557 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
23558 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
23560 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
23561 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
23562 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
23563 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
23564 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
23565 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
23566 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
23568 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
23569 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
23570 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
23571 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
23574 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
23575 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
23576 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
23577 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
23579 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
23580 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
23581 facility; you do not have to use it.
23583 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
23584 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
23585 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
23586 address to which it applies.
23588 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
23589 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
23590 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
23591 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
23592 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
23593 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
23596 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
23597 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
23598 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
23599 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
23602 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
23603 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
23604 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
23605 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
23606 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
23609 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
23610 illustrated by these examples:
23613 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
23614 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
23615 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
23616 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
23618 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
23619 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
23624 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
23625 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
23626 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
23627 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
23628 message's processing.
23630 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23631 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
23632 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
23633 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
23634 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
23635 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
23636 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
23637 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
23638 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
23640 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23641 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23642 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
23643 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
23644 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
23645 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
23646 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
23647 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
23648 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
23649 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
23651 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
23652 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
23653 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
23654 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
23655 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
23656 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
23658 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
23659 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
23660 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
23662 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
23663 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
23664 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
23665 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
23666 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
23667 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
23668 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
23669 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
23670 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
23672 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
23673 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
23679 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
23680 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
23681 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
23682 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
23683 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
23684 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
23685 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
23686 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
23687 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
23688 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
23690 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
23692 might produce the output
23694 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23695 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23696 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23697 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23698 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23699 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23700 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23701 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23703 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
23704 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
23705 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
23706 set for a particular transport.
23709 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
23710 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
23711 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
23714 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
23716 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
23717 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
23718 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
23719 any colons must be doubled, of course).
23721 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
23722 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
23723 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
23724 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
23727 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
23728 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
23729 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
23731 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
23732 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
23733 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
23734 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
23735 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
23736 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
23737 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
23739 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23740 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23741 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
23742 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
23743 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
23747 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
23748 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23751 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
23752 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
23753 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
23754 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
23755 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
23756 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
23757 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
23758 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
23759 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
23761 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
23762 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
23763 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
23765 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
23766 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
23767 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
23768 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
23769 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
23770 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
23771 of pattern they are set as follows:
23774 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
23775 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
23776 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
23779 *queen@*.fict.example
23781 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
23783 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
23787 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
23788 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
23791 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
23792 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
23793 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
23794 rewriting rule of the form
23796 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
23798 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
23804 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
23805 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
23806 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
23807 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
23808 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
23812 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
23813 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
23814 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
23815 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
23816 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
23818 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
23820 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
23823 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23824 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23825 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
23826 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
23827 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23828 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
23829 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
23830 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
23831 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
23832 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
23833 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
23834 entry written to the panic log.
23838 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
23839 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
23842 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
23845 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
23847 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
23850 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
23851 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
23855 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
23857 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
23858 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
23859 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
23860 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
23861 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
23862 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
23864 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
23865 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
23866 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
23867 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
23868 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
23869 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
23870 &`h`& rewrite all headers
23871 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
23872 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
23873 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
23875 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
23876 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
23877 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
23879 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
23880 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
23883 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
23884 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
23885 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
23886 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
23887 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
23888 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
23889 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
23890 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
23891 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
23893 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23894 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23895 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
23896 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
23897 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
23898 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
23899 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
23900 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
23903 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
23904 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
23905 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
23906 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
23909 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
23910 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
23911 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
23913 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
23914 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
23915 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
23916 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
23918 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
23919 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
23920 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
23922 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
23923 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
23924 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
23925 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
23927 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
23931 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
23934 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
23935 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
23936 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
23937 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
23938 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
23939 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
23940 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
23941 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
23943 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
23944 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
23948 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
23949 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
23951 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
23952 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
23953 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
23955 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
23956 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
23957 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
23958 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
23959 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
23960 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
23961 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
23962 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
23964 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
23965 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
23967 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
23969 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
23970 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
23972 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
23973 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
23974 messages that originate outside the local host:
23976 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
23977 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
23979 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
23982 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
23983 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
23984 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
23985 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
23986 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
23987 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
23988 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
23989 components. For example, the rule
23991 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
23993 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
23994 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
23995 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
23996 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
23997 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
23998 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
23999 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
24006 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24007 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24009 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
24010 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
24011 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
24012 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
24013 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
24014 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
24015 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
24016 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
24017 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
24018 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
24019 address, domain and error.
24021 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
24022 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
24023 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
24024 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
24025 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
24026 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
24027 log selector is set, the message
24028 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
24029 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
24030 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
24031 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
24033 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
24034 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
24035 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
24036 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
24037 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
24038 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
24039 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
24040 domain are maintained independently.
24042 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
24043 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
24044 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
24045 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
24046 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
24047 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
24048 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
24049 the local address is reached.
24051 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
24052 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
24053 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
24054 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
24055 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
24057 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
24058 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
24059 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
24060 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
24061 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
24062 messages that it should now be retaining.
24066 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
24067 .cindex "retry" "rules"
24068 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
24069 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
24070 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
24071 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
24072 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
24073 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
24074 message's sender, respectively.
24077 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
24078 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
24079 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
24080 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
24081 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
24082 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
24085 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24087 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
24090 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24092 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
24093 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
24096 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
24097 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
24098 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
24099 expressions work in address lists.
24101 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
24102 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
24106 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
24107 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
24108 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
24109 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
24110 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
24111 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
24112 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
24113 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
24114 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
24116 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
24117 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
24118 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
24119 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
24122 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
24123 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
24124 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
24125 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
24126 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
24127 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
24128 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
24129 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
24130 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
24131 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
24136 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
24138 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
24139 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
24140 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
24141 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
24142 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
24143 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
24145 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
24149 and the retry rules are
24151 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
24152 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
24154 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
24155 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
24156 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
24157 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
24158 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
24159 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
24161 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
24162 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
24163 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
24164 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
24166 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
24167 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
24168 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
24170 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
24172 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
24173 textual form of the IP address.
24175 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
24176 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
24177 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
24178 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
24181 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
24182 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
24183 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
24185 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
24186 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
24187 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
24189 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
24190 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
24192 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
24193 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
24196 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
24197 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
24198 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
24199 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
24200 retry rule of this form:
24202 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
24204 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
24205 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
24208 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
24209 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
24210 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
24211 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
24213 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
24214 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
24216 .vitem &%refused_A%&
24217 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
24220 A connection was refused.
24222 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
24223 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
24225 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
24226 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
24228 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
24229 A connection attempt timed out.
24231 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
24232 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
24233 obtained from an MX record.
24235 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
24236 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
24237 obtained from an MX record.
24240 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
24242 .vitem &%tls_required%&
24243 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
24244 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
24245 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
24248 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24251 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
24252 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
24253 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
24254 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24255 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
24256 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
24260 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
24261 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
24262 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
24263 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
24264 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
24268 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
24269 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
24270 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
24272 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
24273 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
24274 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
24275 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
24276 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
24277 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
24278 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
24280 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
24281 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
24284 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
24285 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
24286 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
24291 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
24292 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
24293 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
24294 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
24295 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
24298 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
24300 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
24302 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
24304 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
24305 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
24308 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
24310 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
24311 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
24312 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
24313 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
24314 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
24316 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
24317 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
24319 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
24321 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
24322 list is never matched.
24328 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
24329 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
24330 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
24331 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
24333 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
24335 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
24336 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
24337 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
24338 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
24339 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
24341 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
24342 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
24343 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
24344 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
24345 The available algorithms are:
24348 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
24351 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
24352 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
24353 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
24355 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
24356 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
24357 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
24358 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
24359 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
24360 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
24361 queue processing times.
24364 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
24365 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
24366 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
24367 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
24368 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
24369 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
24370 interval is found. The main configuration variable
24371 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
24372 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
24373 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
24374 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
24375 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
24377 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
24378 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
24379 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
24380 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
24381 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
24382 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
24385 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
24386 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
24387 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
24388 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
24389 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
24390 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
24391 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
24392 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
24393 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
24394 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
24395 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
24396 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
24398 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
24399 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
24400 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
24401 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
24402 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
24403 deliveries that have been deferred.
24406 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
24407 Here are some example retry rules:
24409 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
24410 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
24411 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
24412 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24413 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
24414 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
24416 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
24417 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
24418 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
24419 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
24420 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
24421 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
24422 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
24425 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
24426 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
24427 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
24428 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
24429 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
24431 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
24432 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
24433 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
24434 were not obtained from an MX record.
24436 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
24437 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
24438 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
24439 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
24440 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
24444 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
24445 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
24446 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
24447 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
24448 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
24449 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
24450 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
24451 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
24452 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
24453 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
24454 failing for the first time.
24456 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
24457 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
24458 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
24459 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
24461 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
24462 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
24463 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
24468 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
24469 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
24470 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
24471 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
24472 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
24473 default retry rule:
24475 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
24477 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
24478 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
24479 failure for the recipient address that counts.
24481 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
24482 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
24483 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
24484 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
24485 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
24487 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
24488 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
24489 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
24491 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
24492 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
24493 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
24494 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
24495 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
24496 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
24497 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
24498 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
24500 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
24501 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
24502 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
24503 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
24504 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
24507 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24508 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
24509 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24510 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
24511 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
24512 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
24513 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
24514 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
24515 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
24518 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
24519 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
24520 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
24521 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
24522 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
24523 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
24524 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
24525 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
24528 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
24529 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
24530 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
24531 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
24532 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
24533 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
24534 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
24535 time out the address.
24537 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
24538 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
24539 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
24540 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
24541 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
24542 considered immediately.
24543 .ecindex IIDretconf1
24544 .ecindex IIDregconf2
24551 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24552 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24554 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
24555 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
24556 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
24557 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
24558 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
24559 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
24560 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
24561 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
24562 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
24565 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
24566 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
24569 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
24570 the client's EHLO command.
24572 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
24573 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
24575 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
24576 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
24577 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
24578 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
24579 with the AUTH command.
24581 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
24583 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
24584 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
24585 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
24588 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
24589 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
24590 unauthenticated connection.
24593 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
24594 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
24595 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
24596 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
24598 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
24599 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
24600 &`Connected to server.example.`&
24601 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
24602 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
24603 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
24604 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
24605 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
24610 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
24611 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
24612 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
24613 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
24614 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
24615 included by setting
24618 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
24621 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
24625 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
24626 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
24627 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
24628 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
24629 work via a socket interface.
24630 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
24631 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
24632 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
24633 supporting setting a server keytab.
24634 The sixth can be configured to support
24635 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
24636 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
24637 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
24639 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
24640 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
24641 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
24642 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
24643 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
24644 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
24645 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
24647 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
24648 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
24649 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
24650 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
24651 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
24652 both sets of options, is required. For example:
24656 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24657 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
24659 client_secret = secret2
24661 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
24662 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
24664 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
24665 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
24666 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
24669 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
24670 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
24671 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
24672 authenticating data.
24674 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
24675 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
24676 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
24677 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
24678 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
24679 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
24680 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
24681 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
24682 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
24683 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
24686 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
24687 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
24688 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
24689 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
24693 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
24694 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
24695 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
24697 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24698 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
24699 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
24700 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
24701 encrypted by a setting such as:
24703 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
24707 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
24708 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
24709 result is used in the log lines for outbound messasges.
24710 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
24713 .option driver authenticators string unset
24714 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
24715 authenticators is to be used.
24718 .option public_name authenticators string unset
24719 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
24720 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
24721 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
24722 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
24723 defaults to the driver's instance name.
24726 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24727 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
24728 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
24729 mechanism is not advertised.
24730 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
24731 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
24732 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
24735 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24736 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
24737 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
24740 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
24741 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
24743 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
24744 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
24745 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
24746 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
24747 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
24748 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
24749 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24750 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
24751 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
24755 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
24756 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
24757 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
24758 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
24759 out the values of variables.
24760 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
24761 output, and Exim carries on processing.
24764 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
24765 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24766 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
24767 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
24768 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
24769 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
24770 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
24771 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
24772 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
24775 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24776 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
24777 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
24778 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
24779 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
24780 remembered for later use.
24781 How it is used is described in the following section.
24787 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
24788 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
24789 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24790 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
24791 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
24795 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
24796 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
24798 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
24800 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
24801 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
24802 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
24803 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
24804 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
24805 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
24806 given for the MAIL command.
24808 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
24809 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
24812 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
24813 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
24814 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
24815 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
24816 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
24817 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
24818 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
24823 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
24824 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
24825 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
24826 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
24828 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24829 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
24830 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
24831 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
24832 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
24837 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
24838 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
24839 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
24840 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
24844 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
24846 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
24847 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
24850 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
24851 the mechanisms are advertised.
24853 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
24854 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
24855 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
24856 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
24857 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
24858 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
24859 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
24861 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
24863 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
24865 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
24866 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
24867 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
24870 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
24872 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
24873 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
24874 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
24876 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
24877 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
24878 command. This is the case if
24881 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
24883 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
24885 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
24886 server authenticators.
24890 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
24891 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
24892 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
24894 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
24895 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
24896 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
24897 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
24898 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
24899 rejected with a 504 error.
24901 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
24902 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
24903 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
24904 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
24905 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
24906 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
24907 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
24908 no successful authentication.
24913 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
24914 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
24915 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
24916 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
24917 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
24918 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
24919 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
24923 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
24925 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
24926 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
24927 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
24928 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
24929 command line to run this script on such data might be
24931 encode '\0user\0password'
24933 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
24934 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
24935 whose code value is zero.
24937 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
24938 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
24939 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
24940 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
24942 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
24943 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
24944 example, a command such as
24946 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
24948 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
24950 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
24951 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
24953 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
24955 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
24956 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
24957 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
24958 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
24962 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
24963 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
24964 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
24965 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
24966 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
24967 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
24970 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
24971 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
24972 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
24973 of the authenticator.
24976 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24977 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
24978 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
24979 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
24980 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
24981 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
24982 delivery to be deferred.
24984 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
24985 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
24986 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
24989 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
24990 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
24991 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
24992 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
24993 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
24994 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
24995 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
24996 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
24997 deliver the message unauthenticated.
25000 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25001 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
25002 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
25003 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
25004 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
25005 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
25006 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
25007 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
25008 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
25009 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
25010 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
25011 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
25012 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
25019 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25020 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25022 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
25023 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
25024 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
25025 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
25026 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
25027 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
25028 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
25029 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
25030 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
25031 connections as you do for login accounts.
25033 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
25034 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
25035 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
25037 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25038 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
25039 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
25041 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
25042 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
25043 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
25046 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
25047 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25048 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25049 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
25050 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25051 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25052 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25054 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
25055 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
25056 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
25057 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
25058 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
25059 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
25060 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
25062 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
25063 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
25064 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
25065 string expansions that also use them for other things.
25067 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
25068 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
25069 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
25071 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25072 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
25073 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
25074 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
25075 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
25076 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25077 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
25078 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
25079 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
25080 string as the error text
25082 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
25083 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
25084 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
25088 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
25089 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
25090 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
25091 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25092 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
25093 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
25094 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
25095 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
25097 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
25098 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
25099 configured as follows:
25103 public_name = PLAIN
25105 server_condition = \
25106 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
25107 server_set_id = $auth2
25109 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
25110 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
25111 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
25112 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
25114 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
25115 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
25116 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
25117 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
25121 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
25123 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
25125 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
25126 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
25130 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
25131 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
25133 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
25134 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
25135 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
25136 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
25137 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
25139 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
25140 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
25141 authenticating clients it could make sense.
25143 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
25144 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
25145 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
25146 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
25147 This is an incorrect example:
25149 server_condition = \
25150 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
25152 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
25153 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
25154 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
25155 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
25156 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
25157 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
25158 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
25160 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
25161 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
25163 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
25164 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
25165 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
25166 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
25167 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
25170 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
25171 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
25172 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
25173 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
25174 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
25175 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
25176 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
25180 public_name = LOGIN
25181 server_prompts = User Name : Password
25182 server_condition = \
25183 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
25184 server_set_id = $auth1
25186 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
25187 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
25188 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
25189 strings are used to obtain two data items.
25191 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
25192 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
25193 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
25194 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
25195 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
25199 public_name = LOGIN
25200 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
25201 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
25204 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
25205 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
25206 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
25207 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
25209 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
25210 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
25211 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
25212 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
25213 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
25214 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
25215 uninterpreted string.
25218 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
25219 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
25220 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
25221 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
25222 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
25228 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
25229 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
25230 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
25232 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
25233 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
25234 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
25235 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
25238 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
25239 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
25240 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
25241 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
25242 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
25243 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
25244 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
25245 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
25246 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
25247 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
25248 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
25249 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
25251 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
25252 splitting takes priority and happens first.
25254 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
25255 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
25256 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
25257 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
25260 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
25261 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
25265 public_name = PLAIN
25266 client_send = ^username^mysecret
25268 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
25269 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
25270 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
25274 public_name = LOGIN
25275 client_send = : username : mysecret
25277 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
25278 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
25280 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
25281 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
25286 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25287 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25289 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
25290 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25291 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
25292 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
25293 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
25294 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
25295 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
25296 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
25297 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
25298 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
25299 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
25300 available in plain text at either end.
25303 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
25304 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
25305 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
25306 authenticator as a server:
25308 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25309 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25310 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
25311 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
25312 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
25313 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
25314 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
25315 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
25316 returned to the client.
25318 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
25319 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
25320 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
25321 numeric variables for other things.
25323 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
25324 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
25325 user name, authentication fails.
25329 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25330 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
25331 server_set_id = $auth1
25333 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25334 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
25335 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
25336 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
25340 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25341 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
25343 server_set_id = $auth1
25345 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
25346 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
25348 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
25349 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
25350 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
25355 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25356 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
25357 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}}
25358 server_set_id = $auth1
25361 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
25362 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
25363 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
25367 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
25368 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
25369 computing the response to the server's challenge.
25372 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25373 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
25374 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
25378 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25379 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
25380 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
25381 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
25382 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
25383 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
25384 send the message to the current server.
25386 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
25391 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25393 client_secret = secret
25395 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
25396 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
25400 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25401 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25403 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
25404 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
25405 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
25406 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
25408 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
25409 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
25411 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
25412 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
25413 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
25414 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
25415 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
25417 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
25418 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
25419 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
25420 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
25422 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
25423 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
25424 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
25425 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
25426 depending on the driver you are using.
25428 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
25429 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
25430 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
25431 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
25432 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
25435 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
25436 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
25437 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
25438 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
25439 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
25440 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
25441 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
25442 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
25445 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
25446 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
25447 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
25448 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
25449 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
25450 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
25454 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
25455 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25456 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
25457 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
25460 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
25461 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25462 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25463 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25467 driver = cyrus_sasl
25468 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25469 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25470 server_set_id = $auth1
25473 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
25474 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25477 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
25478 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25481 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
25482 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
25483 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
25484 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
25487 driver = cyrus_sasl
25488 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25489 server_set_id = $auth1
25492 driver = cyrus_sasl
25493 public_name = PLAIN
25494 server_set_id = $auth2
25496 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
25497 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
25498 but it is present in many binary distributions.
25499 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
25500 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
25505 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25506 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25507 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
25508 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
25509 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
25510 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
25511 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
25512 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
25513 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
25514 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
25515 authenticator only. There is only one option:
25517 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
25519 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
25520 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
25521 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
25522 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
25526 public_name = PLAIN
25527 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25528 server_set_id = $auth1
25533 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25534 server_set_id = $auth1
25536 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
25537 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
25538 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
25539 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
25540 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
25541 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
25542 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
25543 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
25546 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25547 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25548 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
25549 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
25550 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
25551 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
25552 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
25553 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25554 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25555 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
25556 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
25557 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
25558 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
25559 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
25560 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
25561 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
25562 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
25563 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
25564 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
25565 without code changes in Exim.
25568 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
25569 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
25570 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
25571 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
25572 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
25575 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
25576 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
25577 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
25579 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
25580 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
25581 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
25583 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
25584 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
25585 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
25588 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
25589 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25590 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25591 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25594 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
25595 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25596 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25597 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25602 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25603 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25604 server_set_id = $auth1
25608 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
25609 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
25610 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
25611 the password itself.
25613 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
25614 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
25615 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
25616 if available, else the empty string.
25617 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
25618 else the empty string.
25620 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
25622 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
25623 option to be simply "true".
25626 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
25627 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25628 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25631 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
25632 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25633 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25634 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25637 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
25638 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25639 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25640 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25643 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
25644 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25645 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25648 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
25649 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25650 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
25651 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
25653 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
25654 meanings for these variables:
25657 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
25658 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
25660 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
25661 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
25663 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
25664 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
25667 On a per-mechanism basis:
25670 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25671 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
25672 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25674 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25675 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
25676 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25678 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25679 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
25680 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
25681 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25684 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
25685 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
25686 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
25689 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
25690 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
25692 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
25694 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25695 server_realm = imap.example.org
25696 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
25697 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25698 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
25699 server_condition = yes
25703 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25704 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25706 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
25707 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
25708 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
25709 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25710 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
25711 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
25712 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
25715 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
25716 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
25717 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
25718 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25720 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
25721 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
25722 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
25723 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
25725 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
25726 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
25727 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifer for finding credentials
25731 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
25732 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
25733 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
25734 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
25736 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
25737 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
25738 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
25739 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
25741 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25743 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
25744 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
25746 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
25747 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
25748 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
25753 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25754 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25756 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
25757 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
25758 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
25759 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
25760 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
25761 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
25762 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
25763 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
25764 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
25765 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
25766 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
25767 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
25768 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
25772 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
25773 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
25775 The server sends back a challenge.
25777 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
25778 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
25781 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
25785 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
25786 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
25787 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
25789 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
25790 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
25791 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
25792 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
25793 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
25794 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
25795 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
25796 for other things. For example:
25801 server_password = \
25802 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
25804 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
25805 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
25811 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
25812 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
25813 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
25817 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
25818 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
25821 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
25822 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
25825 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
25826 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
25827 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
25833 client_username = msn/msn_username
25834 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
25835 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
25837 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
25838 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
25844 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25845 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25847 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
25848 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
25849 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
25850 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
25851 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
25854 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
25855 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
25856 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
25857 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
25858 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
25859 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
25860 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
25861 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
25862 certificates are used.
25864 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
25865 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
25866 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
25867 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
25868 between them is encrypted.
25870 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
25871 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
25872 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
25873 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
25876 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
25877 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
25878 in order to get TLS to work.
25882 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
25884 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
25885 .cindex "smtps protocol"
25886 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
25887 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
25888 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
25889 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
25890 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
25891 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
25892 allocated for this purpose.
25894 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
25895 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
25896 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
25897 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
25899 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
25901 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
25902 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
25903 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
25904 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
25905 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
25908 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
25909 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
25916 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
25917 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
25918 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
25919 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
25920 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
25924 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
25928 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
25929 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
25931 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
25934 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
25935 name of a directory for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
25936 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
25938 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
25940 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
25941 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
25942 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
25943 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
25944 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
25946 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
25947 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
25948 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
25949 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
25950 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
25951 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
25952 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
25955 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
25956 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
25958 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
25959 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
25960 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
25961 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
25963 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
25964 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
25965 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
25966 implementation, then patches are welcome.
25970 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
25971 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
25972 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
25973 but not the chosen filename.
25974 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
25975 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
25977 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
25978 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
25979 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
25980 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
25982 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
25983 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
25984 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
25985 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
25986 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
25987 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
25988 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
25990 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
25991 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
25992 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
25993 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
25994 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
25996 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
25997 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
25998 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
25999 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
26000 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
26001 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
26003 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
26004 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
26005 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
26007 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
26008 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
26009 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
26010 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
26013 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
26016 # chown exim:exim new-params
26017 # chmod 0600 new-params
26018 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
26019 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
26020 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
26021 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
26022 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
26023 # chmod 0400 new-params
26024 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
26026 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
26027 stalling is removed.
26029 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
26030 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
26031 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
26032 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
26033 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
26034 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
26035 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
26036 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
26037 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
26038 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
26039 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
26041 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
26042 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
26043 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
26044 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
26046 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
26047 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
26048 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
26049 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
26050 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
26053 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
26054 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
26055 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
26056 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
26057 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
26058 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
26059 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
26060 directly to this function call.
26061 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
26062 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
26063 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
26064 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
26067 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
26069 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
26070 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
26071 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
26074 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
26075 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
26076 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
26080 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
26083 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
26084 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
26087 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
26088 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
26090 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
26091 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
26094 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
26095 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
26096 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
26097 not be moved to the end of the list.
26100 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
26103 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
26104 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
26107 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26108 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
26109 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
26110 choice of clients used:
26112 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
26113 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26120 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
26122 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
26123 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
26124 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
26125 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
26126 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
26127 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
26128 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
26129 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
26130 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
26131 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
26133 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string.
26135 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
26136 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
26137 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
26138 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
26139 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
26140 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
26142 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
26143 "Priority strings". This is online as
26144 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
26145 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
26146 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
26147 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
26148 on that site can be used to test a given string.
26150 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
26151 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
26152 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
26154 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26155 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
26156 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
26157 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
26161 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26167 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
26168 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
26169 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
26170 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
26171 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
26172 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
26173 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
26174 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
26176 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
26177 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
26178 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
26181 554 Security failure
26183 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
26184 rejected with a 554 error code.
26186 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
26187 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
26188 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
26189 without some further configuration at the server end.
26191 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
26192 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
26194 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
26195 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
26197 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
26198 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
26199 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
26200 that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
26201 always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
26202 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
26203 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
26204 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
26205 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
26206 the server's certificate.
26208 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
26209 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
26210 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
26212 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
26213 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
26214 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
26217 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
26218 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
26219 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
26221 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
26223 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
26224 with the parameters contained in the file.
26225 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
26230 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
26231 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
26232 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
26233 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
26239 for a way of generating file data.
26241 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
26242 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
26243 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
26244 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
26245 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
26247 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26248 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26249 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26250 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
26251 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
26252 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
26253 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
26254 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
26255 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
26257 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
26258 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
26259 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
26260 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
26261 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
26262 documentation for more details.
26264 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
26265 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
26268 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
26269 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26270 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26271 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
26272 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
26273 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
26274 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
26275 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
26276 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
26277 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
26278 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
26279 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
26281 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
26284 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
26285 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
26286 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
26288 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
26290 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
26292 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
26293 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
26294 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
26295 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
26296 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
26297 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
26298 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
26299 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
26300 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
26301 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
26303 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26304 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
26305 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
26306 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
26308 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26309 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
26310 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
26311 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
26312 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
26313 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
26316 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
26317 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
26318 .cindex "revocation list"
26319 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
26320 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
26321 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
26322 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
26323 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
26324 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
26325 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
26327 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
26328 file from every certificate authority they know of.
26330 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
26331 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
26332 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
26333 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
26334 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
26335 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
26337 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
26338 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
26339 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
26340 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
26342 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
26343 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
26344 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
26345 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
26346 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
26347 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
26348 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
26349 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
26351 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
26352 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.1.3,
26353 support for OCSP stapling is included.
26355 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26356 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
26357 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
26358 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
26359 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
26361 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
26362 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
26363 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
26364 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
26365 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
26368 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
26369 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
26372 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
26373 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
26374 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
26375 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
26376 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
26377 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26379 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
26380 not any of the chain from CA to it.
26382 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
26385 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
26386 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
26387 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
26389 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
26390 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
26391 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
26397 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
26398 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26399 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26400 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26401 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
26402 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
26403 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
26404 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
26405 within the &(smtp)& transport.
26407 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
26408 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
26409 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
26410 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
26411 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
26413 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
26414 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
26415 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
26416 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
26417 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
26420 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
26421 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
26422 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
26423 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
26424 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
26425 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
26426 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
26427 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
26428 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26429 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26432 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
26433 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
26434 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
26435 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
26437 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
26438 must name a file or,
26439 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
26440 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
26441 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
26442 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
26443 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
26444 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
26446 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
26447 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
26448 or need not succeed respectively.
26450 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
26451 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
26452 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
26454 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
26455 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
26456 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
26459 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
26460 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
26461 for OCSP to be relevant.
26464 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
26465 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
26466 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
26467 alternative hosts, if any.
26470 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
26471 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
26472 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
26476 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26477 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
26478 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
26479 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
26480 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
26482 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
26483 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
26484 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
26485 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
26486 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
26487 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
26488 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
26489 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
26490 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
26491 outgoing connection.
26495 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
26496 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
26497 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
26498 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
26499 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
26500 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
26501 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
26502 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
26503 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
26504 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
26507 This is analagous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
26508 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
26511 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
26512 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
26513 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
26514 be of limited use in that environment.
26516 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
26517 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
26518 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
26519 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
26520 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
26522 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
26523 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
26524 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
26525 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
26526 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
26528 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
26529 received from a client.
26530 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
26532 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
26533 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
26534 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
26537 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
26538 &%tls_certificate%&
26540 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
26543 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
26546 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
26547 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
26549 .vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
26550 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
26553 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
26554 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
26555 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
26556 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
26558 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
26561 When Exim is built againt OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
26562 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
26563 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
26564 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
26566 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
26567 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
26568 built, then you have SNI support).
26572 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
26574 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
26575 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
26576 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
26577 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
26578 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
26579 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
26580 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
26581 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
26582 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
26583 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
26584 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
26586 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
26587 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
26588 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
26589 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
26590 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
26591 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
26592 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
26593 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
26594 and delay other deliveries to that host.
26596 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
26597 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
26598 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
26599 information is recorded.
26601 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
26602 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
26603 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
26608 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
26609 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
26610 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
26611 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
26612 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
26613 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
26614 to Apache, currently at
26616 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
26618 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
26619 links to further files.
26620 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
26621 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
26622 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
26624 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
26628 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
26629 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
26630 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
26631 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
26632 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
26633 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
26634 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
26635 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
26636 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
26637 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
26638 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
26639 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
26640 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
26642 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
26643 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
26644 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
26645 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
26649 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
26650 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
26651 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
26652 with OpenSSL, like this:
26653 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
26654 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
26656 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
26659 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
26660 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
26661 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
26662 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
26663 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
26664 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
26665 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
26667 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
26668 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
26669 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
26670 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
26671 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
26672 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
26674 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
26675 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
26676 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
26677 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
26678 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
26679 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
26680 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
26681 be a sensible resolution).
26683 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
26684 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
26685 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
26687 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
26688 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
26689 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
26690 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
26691 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
26692 signed with that self-signed certificate.
26694 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
26695 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
26696 Open-source PKI book, available online at
26697 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
26698 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
26699 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
26703 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26704 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26706 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
26707 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
26708 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
26709 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
26710 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
26711 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
26712 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
26713 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
26714 one very small ACL:
26718 accept hosts = one.host.only
26720 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
26721 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
26723 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
26724 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
26725 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
26726 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
26727 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
26728 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
26729 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
26730 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
26733 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
26734 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
26735 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
26736 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
26737 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
26741 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
26742 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
26743 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
26744 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
26745 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
26746 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
26747 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
26748 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
26749 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
26750 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
26751 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
26752 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
26753 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
26754 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
26755 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
26756 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
26757 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
26758 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
26759 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
26762 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
26763 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
26764 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
26765 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
26766 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
26767 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
26768 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
26769 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
26770 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
26771 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
26772 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
26773 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
26774 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
26775 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
26776 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
26777 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
26778 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
26779 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
26780 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
26783 For example, if you set
26785 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
26787 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
26788 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
26789 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
26790 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
26791 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
26792 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
26793 testing as possible at RCPT time.
26796 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
26797 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
26798 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
26799 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
26800 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
26801 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
26802 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
26803 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
26804 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
26805 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
26806 in any of these ACLs.
26808 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
26809 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
26810 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
26811 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
26812 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
26813 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
26814 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
26815 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
26817 control = suppress_local_fixups
26819 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
26820 run, it is too late.
26822 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26823 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26825 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
26826 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
26827 temporary error for these kinds of message.
26830 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
26831 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
26832 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
26833 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
26834 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
26835 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
26836 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
26837 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
26838 &%smtp_banner%& option.
26841 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
26842 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
26843 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
26844 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
26845 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
26846 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
26847 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
26848 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
26849 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
26851 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
26852 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
26853 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
26854 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
26858 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
26859 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
26860 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
26861 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
26862 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
26863 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
26864 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
26865 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
26866 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
26867 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
26869 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
26870 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
26871 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
26872 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
26873 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
26874 associated with the DATA command.
26876 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
26877 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
26878 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
26879 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
26880 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
26883 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
26884 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
26885 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
26886 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
26888 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
26889 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
26890 enabled (which is the default).
26892 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
26893 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
26894 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
26896 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
26898 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
26901 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
26902 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26903 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26905 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
26908 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
26909 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
26910 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
26911 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
26912 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
26913 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
26916 The ACL test specfied by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
26917 has been recieved, and is executed for each recipient of the message.
26918 The test may accept or deny for inividual recipients.
26919 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
26920 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
26921 for some or all recipients.
26923 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
26924 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
26925 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
26926 for this can be disabled when the MAIL-time $smtp_command included
26927 "PRDR". Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
26928 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
26929 will avoid doing so in some situations (eg. single-recipient mails).
26931 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
26932 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
26934 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
26935 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
26936 the feature was not requested by the client.
26938 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
26939 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
26940 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
26941 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
26942 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
26943 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
26945 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
26946 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
26947 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
26948 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
26950 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
26951 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
26953 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
26954 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
26957 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
26958 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
26959 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
26960 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
26961 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
26964 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
26965 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
26966 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
26967 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
26968 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
26969 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
26970 situation even worse.
26972 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
26973 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
26974 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
26977 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
26978 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
26979 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
26980 connection. The possible values are:
26982 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
26983 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
26984 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
26985 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
26986 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
26987 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
26988 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
26989 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
26990 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
26991 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
26993 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
26994 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
26995 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
26996 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
26997 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
27001 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
27002 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
27003 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
27004 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
27006 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
27007 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
27009 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
27010 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
27011 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
27012 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
27013 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
27015 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
27016 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
27017 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
27020 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
27021 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
27022 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
27023 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
27024 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
27025 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
27027 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
27028 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
27029 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
27031 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
27032 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
27033 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
27034 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
27036 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
27037 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
27038 matches the string.
27040 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
27041 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
27042 want to have something like
27044 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
27046 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
27047 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
27053 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
27054 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
27055 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
27056 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
27057 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
27058 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
27059 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
27060 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
27061 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
27063 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
27064 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
27065 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
27068 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
27069 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
27070 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
27071 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
27073 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
27074 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
27075 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
27076 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
27077 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
27078 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
27079 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
27082 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
27083 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
27084 recipients; it may create new recipients.
27088 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
27089 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
27090 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
27091 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
27092 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
27093 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
27095 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
27096 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
27097 used to accept or reject anything.
27099 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
27100 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
27101 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
27102 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
27104 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
27105 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
27106 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
27107 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
27108 configuration file.
27113 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
27114 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
27116 .vindex &$local_part$&
27117 .vindex &$sender_address$&
27118 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
27119 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27120 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
27121 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
27122 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
27123 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
27124 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
27125 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27127 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
27128 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
27129 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
27132 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
27133 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
27134 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
27135 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
27136 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
27139 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
27140 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
27141 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
27142 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
27143 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
27144 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
27145 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
27146 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
27152 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
27153 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
27154 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
27155 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27156 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
27157 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
27158 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27159 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
27160 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
27161 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
27162 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
27163 unencrypted connections.
27166 accept encrypted = *
27167 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
27169 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
27171 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
27172 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
27173 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
27174 option to do this.)
27178 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
27179 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
27180 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
27181 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
27182 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
27183 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
27184 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
27186 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
27187 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
27188 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
27191 deny dnslists = list1.example
27192 dnslists = list2.example
27194 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
27195 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
27196 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
27197 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
27198 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
27201 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
27202 The ACL verbs are as follows:
27205 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
27206 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
27207 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
27208 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
27209 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
27210 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
27211 check a RCPT command:
27213 accept domains = +local_domains
27217 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
27218 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
27219 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
27220 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
27223 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
27224 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
27225 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
27228 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
27229 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
27230 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
27231 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
27232 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
27233 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
27235 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
27236 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
27238 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
27239 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
27240 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
27242 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
27243 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
27244 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
27249 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
27250 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
27251 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
27252 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
27253 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
27254 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
27255 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
27259 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
27260 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
27261 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
27264 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27266 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
27270 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
27271 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
27272 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
27273 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
27274 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
27275 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
27276 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
27277 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
27278 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
27280 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
27281 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
27282 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
27286 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
27287 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
27288 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
27290 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
27291 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
27293 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
27294 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
27297 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
27298 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
27299 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
27300 example, when checking a RCPT command,
27302 require message = Sender did not verify
27305 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
27306 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
27307 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
27308 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
27311 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27312 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
27313 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
27314 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
27315 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
27316 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
27317 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
27319 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
27320 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
27321 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
27322 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
27323 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27325 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
27326 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
27327 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
27328 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
27329 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
27330 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
27334 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27335 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
27336 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
27337 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
27339 warn !verify = sender
27340 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
27344 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
27346 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
27347 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
27348 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
27349 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
27350 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
27354 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
27355 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
27356 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
27357 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
27358 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
27359 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
27360 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
27361 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
27362 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
27363 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
27365 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
27366 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
27367 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
27368 on the same SMTP connection.
27370 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
27371 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
27372 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
27375 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
27376 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
27377 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
27379 accept hosts = whatever
27380 set acl_m4 = some value
27381 accept authenticated = *
27382 set acl_c_auth = yes
27384 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
27385 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
27386 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
27388 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
27389 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
27390 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
27391 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
27392 error is generated.
27394 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
27395 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
27398 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
27399 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
27400 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
27401 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
27403 deny domains = *.dom.example
27404 !verify = recipient
27406 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
27407 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
27408 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
27409 two statements are equivalent:
27411 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
27412 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
27414 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
27415 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
27417 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
27418 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
27419 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
27421 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27422 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
27423 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27424 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
27426 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
27427 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
27428 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
27429 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
27430 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
27431 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
27432 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
27434 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
27435 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
27436 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
27437 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
27438 message is handled.
27440 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
27441 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
27442 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
27443 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
27445 require message = Can't verify sender
27447 message = Can't verify recipient
27449 message = This message cannot be used
27451 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
27452 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
27453 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
27454 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
27455 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
27456 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
27458 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
27459 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
27460 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
27461 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
27464 !senders = *@my.domain.example
27465 message = Invalid sender from client host
27467 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
27468 by which time Exim has set up the message.
27472 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
27473 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
27474 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
27477 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27478 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
27479 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
27480 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27482 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27483 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
27484 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
27485 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
27486 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
27487 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
27488 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
27489 write rather ugly lines like this:
27491 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
27493 Instead, all you need is
27495 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
27498 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27499 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
27500 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
27501 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
27502 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
27503 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
27504 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
27505 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
27507 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
27508 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
27509 in several different ways. For example:
27511 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
27512 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
27513 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
27517 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
27519 accept ...some conditions
27520 control = queue_only
27522 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
27523 other words, when the conditions are all true.
27526 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
27528 accept ...some conditions...
27529 control = queue_only
27530 ...some more conditions...
27532 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
27533 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
27534 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
27538 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
27539 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
27542 warn ...some conditions...
27546 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
27547 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
27551 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
27552 &%require%& verb. For example:
27554 require control = no_multiline_responses
27558 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
27559 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
27561 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
27562 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
27563 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
27564 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
27565 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
27566 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
27568 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
27571 deny ...some conditions...
27574 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
27575 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
27578 ...some conditions...
27580 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
27581 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
27583 warn ...some conditions...
27589 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
27590 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
27591 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
27592 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
27593 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
27594 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
27595 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
27599 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
27600 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
27601 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
27602 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
27603 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
27604 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
27605 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
27608 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27609 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
27610 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
27611 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
27613 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
27614 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
27616 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
27619 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
27620 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
27622 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
27623 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
27624 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
27627 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
27628 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
27629 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
27630 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
27631 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
27632 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
27635 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27636 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
27637 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
27640 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
27641 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
27642 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
27643 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
27644 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
27645 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
27647 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
27648 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
27649 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
27650 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
27651 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
27652 logging rejections.
27655 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
27656 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
27657 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
27658 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
27659 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
27660 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
27661 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
27662 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
27664 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
27665 &` log_reject_target =`&
27667 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
27668 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
27672 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27673 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
27674 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
27675 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
27676 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
27677 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
27678 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
27681 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
27682 &` control = freeze`&
27683 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
27685 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
27686 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
27687 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
27690 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
27691 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
27695 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27696 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
27697 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
27698 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
27699 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
27700 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
27701 &%accept%& for details.)
27703 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
27704 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
27705 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
27706 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
27707 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
27709 require message = Host not recognized
27712 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
27715 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
27716 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
27717 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
27718 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
27719 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
27720 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
27721 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
27722 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
27723 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
27726 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
27727 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
27728 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
27730 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
27731 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
27733 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
27734 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
27735 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
27738 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
27739 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
27741 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
27742 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
27743 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
27746 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27748 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
27749 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
27752 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
27753 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
27754 However, the original message is available in the variable
27755 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
27756 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
27757 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
27758 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
27760 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
27761 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
27762 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
27763 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
27764 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
27765 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
27769 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27770 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
27771 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
27772 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
27775 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
27776 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
27777 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
27778 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
27781 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
27782 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
27783 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
27784 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
27785 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
27786 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
27787 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
27788 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
27791 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
27792 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
27799 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
27800 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
27801 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
27804 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
27805 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
27806 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
27807 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
27808 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
27809 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
27810 not work without it. For example:
27812 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
27813 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
27815 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
27816 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
27817 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
27818 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
27819 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
27822 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
27823 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
27824 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
27825 .cindex "case of local parts"
27826 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
27827 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
27828 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
27829 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
27830 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
27831 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
27834 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
27835 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
27836 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
27837 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
27838 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
27840 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
27841 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
27844 warn control = caseful_local_part
27845 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
27847 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
27849 control = caselower_local_part
27851 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
27852 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
27855 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
27856 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
27857 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
27858 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
27859 It is usable in the RCPT ACL and valid only for single-recipient mails forwarded
27860 from one SMTP connection to another. If a recipient-verify callout connection is
27861 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for the data, otherwise one is made
27862 after the ACL completes.
27864 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
27865 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
27866 Note also that headers cannot be
27867 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
27868 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
27870 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
27871 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
27872 before the entire message has been received from the source.
27874 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
27875 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
27876 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
27877 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode the log line
27878 is tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appears before the acceptance "<="
27881 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a (possibly faked)
27882 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
27885 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
27886 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
27887 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
27888 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
27889 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
27890 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
27891 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
27892 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
27893 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
27897 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
27898 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
27899 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
27903 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
27904 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
27905 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
27906 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
27907 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27910 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
27911 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
27912 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
27913 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
27914 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
27915 strings or to numeric value.
27916 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
27917 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
27918 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
27920 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
27921 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
27922 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
27923 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
27924 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
27927 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
27928 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
27929 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
27930 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
27931 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
27932 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
27933 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
27934 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
27936 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
27937 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
27938 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
27939 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
27940 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
27941 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
27945 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
27946 .cindex "fake defer"
27947 .cindex "defer, fake"
27948 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
27949 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
27950 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
27951 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
27952 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
27954 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
27955 .cindex "fake rejection"
27956 .cindex "rejection, fake"
27957 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
27958 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
27959 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
27960 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
27961 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
27962 the same SMTP connection.
27964 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
27965 message is supplied, the following is used:
27967 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
27968 550-kept for evaluation.
27969 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
27970 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
27972 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
27974 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
27975 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
27976 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
27977 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
27978 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
27979 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
27982 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
27983 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
27984 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
27985 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
27987 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
27988 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
27989 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
27990 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
27991 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
27992 disables such output flushing.
27994 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
27995 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
27996 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
27997 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
27998 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
27999 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
28001 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
28002 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
28003 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
28004 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
28005 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
28006 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
28007 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28008 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
28009 to be useful in production.
28011 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
28012 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
28013 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
28014 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
28015 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
28017 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
28018 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
28019 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
28020 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
28021 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
28022 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
28025 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
28026 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
28027 verification failed"&) is sent.
28029 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
28033 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
28034 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
28036 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
28037 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
28038 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
28039 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
28040 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
28041 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
28042 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
28044 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
28045 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
28046 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
28047 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28048 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28049 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
28050 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
28051 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
28052 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
28053 same SMTP connection.
28055 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
28056 .cindex "message" "submission"
28057 .cindex "submission mode"
28058 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
28059 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
28060 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
28061 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
28062 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
28063 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
28064 late (the message has already been created).
28066 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
28067 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
28068 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
28069 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
28070 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
28072 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
28073 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
28074 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
28075 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
28076 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
28079 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
28080 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
28082 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
28084 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
28087 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
28088 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
28089 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28090 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
28093 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
28094 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
28098 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
28099 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
28102 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
28104 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
28105 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
28107 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
28109 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
28114 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
28115 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
28116 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
28117 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
28118 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
28119 to an incoming message, as in this example:
28121 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28122 dialup.mail-abuse.org
28123 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
28125 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28126 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28127 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28128 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
28129 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
28132 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
28133 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28135 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
28136 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
28137 contains one or more newlines that
28138 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
28139 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
28140 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
28142 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28143 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28144 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
28145 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
28146 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
28147 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
28148 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
28149 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
28150 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
28151 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
28152 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
28154 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
28155 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
28157 until they are added to the
28158 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
28159 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
28160 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
28161 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
28162 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
28163 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
28164 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28166 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
28168 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28169 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28171 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28172 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28174 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28175 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28177 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
28178 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
28179 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
28180 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
28183 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28184 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
28185 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
28186 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
28187 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
28188 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
28189 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
28192 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
28193 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
28194 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
28195 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
28196 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
28198 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
28199 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
28200 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
28201 to be a header name first.) For example:
28203 warn add_header = \
28204 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
28206 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
28207 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
28208 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
28209 up in reverse order.
28211 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28212 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
28213 system filter or in a router or transport.
28217 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
28218 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
28219 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
28220 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
28221 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
28222 from an incoming message, as in this example:
28224 warn message = Remove internal headers
28225 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28227 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28228 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28229 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28230 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
28231 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
28232 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
28234 Headers will not be removed to the message if the modifier is used in
28235 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28237 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
28238 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
28239 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
28240 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
28241 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
28243 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
28244 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28245 warn message = Remove internal headers
28246 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
28248 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28249 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28250 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
28251 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
28252 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
28253 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
28254 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
28255 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
28256 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
28257 would have been removed.
28259 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
28260 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
28261 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
28262 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
28263 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
28264 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
28265 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
28266 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
28267 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28269 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28270 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28272 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
28273 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28275 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28276 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
28278 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
28279 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
28280 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
28281 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
28284 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28285 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
28286 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
28291 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
28292 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
28293 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
28294 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
28295 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
28296 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28298 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
28299 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
28300 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
28301 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
28302 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
28303 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
28304 The conditions are as follows:
28308 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
28309 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
28310 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
28311 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
28312 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
28313 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
28314 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
28315 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
28316 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
28317 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
28318 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
28319 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
28321 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
28322 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
28323 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
28324 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
28325 The name and values are expanded separately.
28326 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
28327 will act as argument separators.
28329 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
28330 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
28331 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
28332 conditions are tested.
28334 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
28335 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
28336 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
28337 for different local users or different local domains.
28339 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28340 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
28341 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
28342 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
28343 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
28344 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
28345 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
28350 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
28351 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
28352 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
28353 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
28354 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
28355 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
28356 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
28357 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
28358 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
28359 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
28360 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
28361 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
28364 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
28365 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
28366 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28367 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28368 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
28369 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
28370 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
28371 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28373 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
28374 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
28375 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28376 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
28377 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
28379 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
28380 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
28381 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28382 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
28383 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28384 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
28385 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
28386 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
28387 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
28388 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
28390 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28391 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
28392 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
28393 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
28394 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
28395 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
28396 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
28397 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
28398 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
28401 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
28402 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
28405 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28406 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
28407 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
28408 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
28409 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
28410 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
28411 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
28417 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
28418 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
28419 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
28420 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
28421 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
28422 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
28423 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
28425 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28427 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
28428 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
28429 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
28431 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
28432 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
28433 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
28434 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
28435 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
28436 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
28438 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
28439 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
28441 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28442 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
28444 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
28445 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
28446 statement can then check the IP address.
28448 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
28449 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
28450 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
28451 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
28453 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
28454 message = $host_data
28456 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
28458 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
28459 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
28460 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
28461 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
28462 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
28463 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
28464 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
28465 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
28466 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
28467 the next &%local_parts%& test.
28469 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
28470 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
28471 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
28472 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
28473 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28474 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
28475 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28477 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
28478 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
28479 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
28480 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28481 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28482 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
28483 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
28486 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
28487 .cindex "rate limiting"
28488 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
28489 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
28491 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
28492 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
28493 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
28494 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
28495 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
28496 recipient address against a list of recipients.
28498 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
28499 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
28500 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
28501 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28502 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
28503 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
28504 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28506 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28507 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
28508 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
28509 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
28510 .vindex "&$domain$&"
28511 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
28512 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
28513 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
28514 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
28515 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
28516 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
28517 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
28518 influence the sender checking.
28520 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
28521 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
28523 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
28524 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
28525 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
28526 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
28527 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
28528 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
28532 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
28533 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
28535 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
28536 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
28537 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
28538 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28539 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
28540 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28542 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
28543 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28544 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28545 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28546 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
28547 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
28548 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
28549 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
28550 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
28551 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28553 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
28554 .cindex "CSA verification"
28555 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
28556 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
28557 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
28559 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
28560 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28561 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
28562 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
28563 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
28564 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28565 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28566 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
28567 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
28568 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
28570 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
28571 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
28572 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
28574 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
28575 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28576 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
28577 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
28578 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
28579 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
28580 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28581 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28582 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
28583 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
28584 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
28585 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
28586 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
28587 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
28588 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
28590 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
28591 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
28592 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
28593 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
28596 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
28597 !verify = header_sender
28600 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
28601 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28602 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
28603 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
28604 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
28605 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28606 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28607 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
28608 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
28609 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
28610 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
28611 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
28614 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
28615 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
28619 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
28620 common as they used to be.
28622 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
28623 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28624 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
28625 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
28626 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
28627 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
28628 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
28629 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
28630 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
28631 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
28632 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
28633 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
28634 independently of this condition.
28636 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
28637 option), this condition is always true.
28640 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
28641 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
28642 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
28643 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
28644 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
28645 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
28646 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
28647 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
28648 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
28650 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
28651 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
28654 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
28655 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28656 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
28657 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
28658 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
28659 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
28660 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
28661 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
28662 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
28663 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
28664 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
28665 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
28666 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
28667 value for the child address.
28669 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
28670 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28671 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
28672 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
28673 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
28674 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
28675 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
28676 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
28677 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
28678 original IP address.
28680 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
28681 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
28683 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
28684 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28685 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
28686 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
28687 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
28688 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
28689 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
28690 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
28691 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
28693 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
28694 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
28695 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
28696 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
28697 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
28698 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
28699 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
28701 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
28702 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
28703 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
28705 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
28706 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28707 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
28708 verified as a sender.
28713 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
28714 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28715 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
28716 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28717 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
28718 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
28719 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
28720 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
28721 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
28722 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
28724 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
28725 dialups.mail-abuse.org
28727 the following records are looked up:
28729 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28730 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
28732 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
28733 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
28734 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
28735 use two separate conditions:
28737 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28738 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
28740 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
28741 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
28742 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
28745 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
28746 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
28747 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
28748 following special items in the list:
28750 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
28751 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
28752 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
28754 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
28755 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
28756 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
28757 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
28759 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
28761 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
28762 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
28764 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28765 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
28766 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
28768 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
28769 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
28770 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
28771 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
28775 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
28776 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
28777 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
28778 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
28779 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
28781 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
28783 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
28784 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
28785 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
28786 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
28791 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
28792 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
28793 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
28794 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
28795 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
28796 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
28797 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
28799 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
28800 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
28802 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
28803 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
28804 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
28805 up by this example is
28807 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
28809 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
28810 addresses. For example:
28812 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28813 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
28815 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
28816 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
28821 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
28822 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
28823 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
28824 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
28825 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
28826 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
28827 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
28828 either to double the separators like this:
28830 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
28832 or to change the separator character, like this:
28834 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
28836 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
28837 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
28838 occurs. Consider this condition:
28840 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
28842 The DNS lookups that occur are:
28844 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
28845 a.domain.black.list.tld
28847 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
28848 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
28849 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
28850 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
28851 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
28852 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
28853 error for a previous item.
28855 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
28856 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
28858 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
28859 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
28861 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
28862 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
28864 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
28865 $sender_address_domain \
28866 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
28868 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
28869 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
28870 $sender_address_domain} }} }
28872 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
28873 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
28874 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
28875 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
28877 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
28879 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
28880 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
28882 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
28883 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
28888 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
28889 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
28890 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
28891 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
28892 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
28893 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
28897 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
28899 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
28900 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
28901 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
28903 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
28904 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
28905 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
28908 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
28909 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
28910 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
28911 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
28912 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
28913 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
28914 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
28915 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
28916 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
28917 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
28918 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
28919 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
28920 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
28921 cases, for example:
28923 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
28925 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
28926 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
28927 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
28928 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
28930 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
28932 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
28933 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
28935 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
28936 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
28937 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
28938 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
28939 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
28942 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
28943 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
28944 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
28946 deny hosts = !+local_networks
28947 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
28949 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
28954 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
28955 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
28956 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
28957 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
28960 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
28962 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
28963 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
28964 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
28965 describes how multiple records are handled.
28967 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
28968 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
28969 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
28971 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28973 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
28974 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
28975 first. For example:
28977 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
28978 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
28981 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
28982 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
28983 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
28984 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
28985 tested. For example:
28987 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
28989 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
28990 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
28991 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
28993 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
28995 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
29000 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
29001 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
29004 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29006 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29007 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
29009 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29011 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29012 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
29013 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
29014 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
29016 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
29017 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
29019 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
29020 previous example is precisely equivalent to
29022 deny dnslists = a.b.c
29023 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29025 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
29026 Consider this example:
29028 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29030 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
29033 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
29035 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29037 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
29038 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
29039 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
29041 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
29046 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
29047 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
29048 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
29049 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
29050 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
29051 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
29053 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
29055 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
29056 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
29057 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
29058 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
29059 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
29060 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
29063 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
29064 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
29065 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29067 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
29068 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
29071 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
29073 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29074 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
29076 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
29078 for the condition to be true.
29081 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
29082 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
29084 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
29085 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
29087 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
29089 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29090 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29092 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
29093 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
29095 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
29097 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29098 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
29100 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29102 for the condition to be false.
29104 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
29105 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
29110 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
29111 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
29112 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
29113 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
29114 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
29115 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
29116 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
29117 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
29118 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
29121 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
29122 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
29123 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
29124 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
29125 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
29126 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
29127 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
29130 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
29131 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
29133 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
29134 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29136 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
29137 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
29138 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
29139 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
29140 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
29141 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
29143 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
29144 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
29145 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
29147 reject dnslists = \
29148 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
29149 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
29150 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
29151 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29153 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
29154 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
29155 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
29159 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
29160 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
29161 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
29162 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
29163 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
29164 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
29166 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
29167 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29169 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
29170 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
29171 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
29173 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
29175 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
29176 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
29178 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
29179 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
29181 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
29182 dnslists = some.list.example
29185 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
29186 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
29187 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
29189 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
29192 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
29193 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
29194 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
29195 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
29196 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
29197 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
29198 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
29199 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
29200 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
29201 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
29203 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
29205 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
29206 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
29208 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
29209 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
29210 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
29213 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
29214 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
29215 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
29216 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
29217 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
29218 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
29219 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
29220 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
29221 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
29223 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
29224 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
29225 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
29226 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
29228 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
29229 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
29230 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
29231 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
29232 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
29233 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
29234 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
29235 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
29236 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
29237 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
29239 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
29240 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
29241 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
29244 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
29245 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
29246 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
29247 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
29248 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
29249 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
29251 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
29252 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
29253 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
29254 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
29255 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
29256 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
29257 the &%count=%& option.
29260 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
29261 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
29262 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
29263 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
29264 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
29266 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
29267 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
29268 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
29269 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
29271 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
29272 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
29273 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
29274 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
29275 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
29276 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
29277 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
29279 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
29280 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29281 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
29282 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
29283 ACLs the rate is updated with the total recipient count in one go. Note that
29284 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
29285 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
29287 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
29288 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
29289 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
29290 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
29293 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
29294 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
29295 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
29296 multiple different commands.
29298 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
29299 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
29300 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
29301 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
29302 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
29304 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
29307 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
29308 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
29309 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
29310 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
29311 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
29313 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
29314 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
29316 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
29317 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
29318 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
29319 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
29323 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
29324 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29325 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29328 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
29329 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29330 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29333 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
29334 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
29335 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
29336 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
29337 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
29338 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
29341 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
29342 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
29343 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
29344 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
29345 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
29348 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
29349 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
29350 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
29351 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
29352 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
29353 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
29356 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
29357 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
29358 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
29359 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
29360 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
29361 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
29362 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
29363 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
29364 from getting any email through.
29366 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
29367 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
29368 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
29369 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
29370 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
29371 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
29372 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
29373 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
29375 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
29379 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
29380 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
29381 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
29382 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
29383 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
29384 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
29385 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
29386 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
29387 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
29389 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
29390 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
29391 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
29392 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
29393 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
29394 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
29396 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
29397 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
29400 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
29401 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
29402 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
29403 required increases with larger limits.
29405 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
29406 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
29407 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
29408 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
29409 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
29410 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
29411 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
29412 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
29413 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
29417 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
29418 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
29419 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
29420 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
29421 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
29422 message. For example:
29424 # Log all senders' rates
29425 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
29426 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
29428 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
29429 # at the decimal point.
29430 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
29431 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
29432 $sender_rate_limit }s
29434 # Keep authenticated users under control
29435 deny authenticated = *
29436 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
29438 # System-wide rate limit
29439 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
29440 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
29442 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
29443 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
29444 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
29445 messages per $sender_rate_period
29446 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
29447 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
29448 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
29450 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
29451 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
29452 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
29453 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
29454 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
29455 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
29456 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
29460 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
29461 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
29462 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
29463 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
29464 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
29465 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
29466 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
29467 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
29468 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
29470 verify = sender/callout
29471 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
29473 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
29474 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
29475 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
29476 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
29477 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
29478 The available options are as follows:
29481 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
29482 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
29483 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
29485 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
29486 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
29487 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
29488 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
29490 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
29491 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
29493 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
29494 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
29495 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
29496 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
29499 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
29500 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
29501 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
29502 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29503 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
29504 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
29507 warn !verify = sender
29508 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
29510 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
29511 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
29512 verification failure.
29514 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
29515 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
29518 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
29519 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
29521 &%route%&: Routing failed.
29523 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
29524 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
29525 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
29527 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
29529 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
29532 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
29533 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
29538 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
29539 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
29540 .cindex "callout" "verification"
29541 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
29542 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
29543 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
29544 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
29545 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
29546 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
29547 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
29548 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
29549 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
29552 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
29553 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
29554 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
29555 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
29556 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
29557 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
29559 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
29560 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
29561 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
29562 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
29563 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
29565 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
29566 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
29567 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
29568 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
29569 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
29570 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
29571 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
29572 supplies a host list.
29573 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
29575 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
29576 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
29577 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
29578 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
29579 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
29580 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
29581 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
29583 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
29584 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
29585 following SMTP commands are sent:
29587 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
29589 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
29592 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
29595 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
29598 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
29599 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
29600 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
29601 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
29602 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
29603 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
29605 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
29606 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
29607 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
29608 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
29609 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
29611 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
29612 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
29613 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
29614 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
29615 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
29620 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
29621 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
29622 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
29623 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
29625 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
29627 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
29628 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
29629 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
29633 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
29634 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
29635 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
29638 verify = sender/callout=5s
29640 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
29641 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
29642 the &%connect%& parameter.
29645 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
29646 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
29647 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
29648 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
29650 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
29652 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
29654 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
29655 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
29656 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
29657 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
29658 updated in this circumstance.
29660 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
29661 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
29662 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
29663 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
29664 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
29665 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
29668 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
29669 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
29670 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
29671 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
29672 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
29673 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
29674 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
29675 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
29676 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
29677 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
29679 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
29681 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
29684 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
29685 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
29686 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
29689 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
29691 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
29692 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
29693 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
29694 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
29695 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
29698 .vitem &*no_cache*&
29699 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
29700 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
29701 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
29703 .vitem &*postmaster*&
29704 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
29705 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
29706 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
29707 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
29708 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
29709 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
29710 made, until the cache record expires.
29712 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
29713 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
29714 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
29717 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
29719 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
29720 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
29722 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
29724 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
29725 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
29726 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
29727 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
29731 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
29732 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
29733 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
29734 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
29735 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
29737 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
29739 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
29740 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
29741 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
29742 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
29743 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
29745 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
29746 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
29747 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
29749 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
29751 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
29752 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
29753 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
29754 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
29755 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
29757 .vitem &*use_sender*&
29758 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
29760 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
29762 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
29763 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
29764 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
29765 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
29766 usefulness of callout caching.
29769 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
29770 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
29771 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
29772 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
29773 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
29774 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
29775 these circumstances.
29777 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
29778 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
29779 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
29780 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
29781 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
29782 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
29783 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
29785 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
29786 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
29787 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
29788 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
29793 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
29794 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
29795 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
29796 .cindex "caching" "callout"
29797 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
29798 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
29799 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
29800 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
29801 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
29802 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
29804 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
29805 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
29808 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
29809 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
29810 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
29812 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
29813 commands up to and including
29817 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
29818 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
29819 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
29820 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
29821 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
29822 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
29823 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
29825 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
29826 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
29827 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
29828 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
29829 will eventually be noticed.
29831 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
29832 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
29833 behaviour will be the same.
29837 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
29838 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
29839 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
29840 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
29841 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
29842 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
29845 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
29847 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
29848 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
29849 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
29850 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
29851 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
29852 550 Sender verification failed
29854 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
29855 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
29856 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
29857 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
29860 verify = sender/no_details
29863 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
29864 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
29865 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
29866 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
29867 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
29868 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
29869 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
29872 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
29873 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
29874 verification also fails.
29876 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
29877 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
29880 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
29881 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
29882 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
29885 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
29887 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
29888 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
29889 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
29890 verification to succeed.
29892 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
29893 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
29894 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
29895 option. For example:
29897 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
29899 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
29900 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
29902 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
29903 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
29904 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
29905 address and a report is output for each of them.
29909 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
29910 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
29911 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
29912 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
29913 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
29914 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
29915 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
29919 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
29920 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
29921 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
29922 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
29923 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
29924 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
29926 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
29927 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
29928 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
29929 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
29932 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
29934 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
29936 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
29937 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
29939 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
29940 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
29943 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
29944 use for the DNS query. The default is:
29946 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
29948 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
29949 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
29950 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
29951 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
29954 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
29956 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
29957 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
29958 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
29960 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
29961 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
29962 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
29963 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
29964 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
29965 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
29966 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
29967 of legitimate HELO domains.
29969 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
29970 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
29971 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
29972 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
29975 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
29977 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
29978 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
29979 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
29984 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
29985 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
29986 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
29987 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
29988 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
29989 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
29990 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
29991 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
29993 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
29994 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
29995 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
29996 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
29997 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
29998 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
29999 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
30001 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
30002 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
30005 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
30006 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
30009 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
30010 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
30013 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
30014 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
30016 recipients = +batv_senders
30018 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
30019 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
30021 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
30022 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
30023 !condition = $prvscheck_result
30025 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
30026 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
30027 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
30028 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
30029 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
30031 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
30032 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
30033 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
30034 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
30035 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
30036 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
30037 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
30039 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
30040 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
30041 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
30042 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
30046 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
30048 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
30049 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
30050 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
30053 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
30056 external_smtp_batv:
30058 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
30059 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
30060 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
30061 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
30064 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
30068 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
30069 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
30070 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
30071 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
30072 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
30073 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
30074 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
30075 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
30076 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
30077 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
30079 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
30080 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
30081 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
30082 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
30083 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
30084 same host is fulfilling both functions,
30086 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
30088 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
30089 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
30090 system to arbitrary domains.
30093 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
30094 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
30095 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
30096 example, suppose you want to do the following:
30099 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
30100 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
30101 &'my.dom2.example'&.
30103 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
30104 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
30106 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
30107 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
30111 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
30113 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
30114 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
30115 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
30117 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
30121 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
30122 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
30124 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
30125 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
30126 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
30127 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
30128 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
30129 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
30130 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30134 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
30135 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
30136 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
30137 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
30138 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30140 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
30141 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
30142 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
30143 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
30144 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
30145 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
30146 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
30151 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30152 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30154 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
30155 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
30156 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
30157 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
30158 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
30159 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
30162 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
30163 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
30164 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
30165 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
30166 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
30168 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
30169 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
30170 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
30173 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
30174 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
30176 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
30177 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
30178 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
30180 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
30181 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
30183 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
30186 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
30189 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
30190 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
30191 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
30193 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
30194 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
30195 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
30196 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
30197 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
30198 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
30200 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
30201 temporarily created in a file called:
30203 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
30205 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
30206 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
30207 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
30208 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
30209 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
30211 control = no_mbox_unspool
30213 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
30214 same directory by default.
30218 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
30219 .cindex "virus scanning"
30220 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
30221 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
30222 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
30223 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
30224 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
30225 in memory and thus are much faster.
30228 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
30229 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
30230 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
30231 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
30233 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
30235 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
30237 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
30239 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
30241 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
30242 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
30245 .vitem &%aveserver%&
30246 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30247 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
30248 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
30249 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
30252 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
30257 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
30258 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
30259 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
30260 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
30261 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
30262 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
30263 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
30265 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
30266 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
30267 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
30268 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
30270 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the local
30271 keyword, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
30272 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
30273 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
30274 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
30275 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
30276 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
30278 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
30279 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
30280 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
30281 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
30282 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
30283 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
30284 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
30285 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
30286 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
30288 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
30289 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
30290 (Connection refused)
30293 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
30294 contributing the code for this scanner.
30297 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
30298 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
30299 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
30300 type takes 3 mandatory options:
30303 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
30304 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
30307 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
30308 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
30309 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
30310 the &"trigger"& expression.
30313 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
30314 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
30315 &"name"& expression.
30318 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
30320 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
30322 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
30323 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
30324 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
30325 configuration setting:
30327 av_scanner = cmdline:\
30328 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
30329 found in file:'(.+)'
30332 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
30333 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
30334 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
30335 separated by white space, as in these examples:
30337 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
30338 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
30340 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
30341 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
30344 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
30345 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
30346 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
30348 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
30350 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
30351 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
30353 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
30354 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30355 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
30356 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
30357 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
30360 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
30362 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
30365 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
30366 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
30367 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
30368 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
30369 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
30370 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
30371 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
30373 av_scanner = mksd:2
30375 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
30378 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
30379 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
30380 running on the local machine.
30381 There are four options:
30382 an address (which may be an IP addres and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
30383 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
30384 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
30385 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
30386 an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
30389 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
30391 Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
30392 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
30393 Both regular-expressions are required.
30396 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
30397 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
30398 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
30399 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
30400 client communication. For example:
30402 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
30404 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
30408 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
30409 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
30412 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
30413 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
30414 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
30415 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
30416 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
30417 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
30420 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
30421 use. It can then be one of
30424 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
30425 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
30428 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
30429 the condition fails immediately.
30431 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
30432 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
30433 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
30436 You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
30437 even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
30438 causes the ACL to defer.
30440 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
30441 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
30442 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
30443 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
30446 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
30447 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
30448 &%malware%& condition.
30450 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
30451 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
30453 Here is a very simple scanning example:
30455 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30459 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
30461 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30463 malware = */defer_ok
30465 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
30466 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
30468 av_scanner = $acl_m0
30470 in the main Exim configuration.
30472 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30473 set acl_m0 = sophie
30476 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30477 set acl_m0 = aveserver
30482 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
30483 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
30484 .cindex "spam scanning"
30485 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
30486 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
30487 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
30488 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
30489 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
30491 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
30493 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
30494 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
30497 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
30498 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
30499 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
30500 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
30501 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
30503 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
30505 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
30506 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
30507 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
30510 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
30512 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
30513 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
30514 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
30515 option, separated with colons:
30517 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
30518 192.168.2.11 783 : \
30521 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
30522 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
30523 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
30526 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
30527 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
30529 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
30530 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
30531 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
30534 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
30535 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
30537 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
30540 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
30541 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
30542 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
30543 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
30544 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
30546 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
30547 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
30548 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
30549 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
30550 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
30553 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
30554 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
30555 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
30558 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
30559 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
30560 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
30563 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
30564 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
30568 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
30569 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
30570 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
30571 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
30573 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
30574 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
30575 variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
30576 available for use at delivery time.
30579 .vitem &$spam_score$&
30580 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
30581 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
30583 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
30584 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
30585 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
30586 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
30587 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
30589 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
30590 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
30591 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
30592 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
30593 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
30595 .vitem &$spam_report$&
30596 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
30597 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
30600 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
30601 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
30602 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
30604 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
30605 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
30606 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
30607 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
30608 spam condition, like this:
30610 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
30611 spam = joe/defer_ok
30613 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
30615 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
30618 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
30619 warn spam = nobody:true
30620 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
30621 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
30623 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
30624 # is over threshold
30626 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
30628 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
30629 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
30631 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
30636 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
30637 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
30638 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
30639 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
30640 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
30641 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
30642 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
30643 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
30644 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
30645 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
30648 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
30649 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
30650 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
30651 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
30652 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
30653 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
30654 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
30656 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
30657 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
30658 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
30659 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
30660 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
30662 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
30663 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
30664 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
30665 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
30666 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
30669 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
30671 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
30675 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
30677 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
30678 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
30679 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
30680 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
30682 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
30683 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
30684 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
30685 the full path and file name.
30687 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
30688 filename, and the default path is then used.
30690 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
30691 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
30692 a file with its original, proposed filename using
30694 decode = $mime_filename
30696 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
30697 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
30698 automatically unlinked.
30700 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
30701 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
30702 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
30703 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
30704 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
30706 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
30707 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
30708 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
30710 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
30711 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
30712 available in the MIME ACL:
30715 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
30716 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
30717 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
30718 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
30719 contains the empty string.
30721 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
30722 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
30723 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
30729 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
30730 case-insensitively.
30732 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
30733 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
30734 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
30735 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
30736 only used for display purposes.
30738 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
30739 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
30740 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
30742 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
30743 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
30744 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
30746 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
30747 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
30748 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
30749 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
30750 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
30752 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
30753 This variable contains the normalized content of the
30754 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
30755 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
30757 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
30758 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
30759 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
30760 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
30764 application/octet-stream
30768 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
30771 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
30772 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
30773 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
30774 containing the decoded data.
30779 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
30780 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
30781 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
30782 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
30783 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
30784 found, this variable contains the empty string.
30786 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
30787 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
30788 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
30789 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
30791 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
30792 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
30796 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
30799 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
30800 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
30803 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
30804 and the rest are attachments.
30807 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
30810 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
30811 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
30812 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
30814 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
30815 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
30816 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
30817 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
30819 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
30820 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
30821 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
30822 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
30823 want to carry out specific actions on them.
30825 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
30826 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
30827 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
30828 decoding is fully recursive.
30830 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
30831 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
30832 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
30833 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
30834 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
30835 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
30836 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
30841 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
30842 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
30843 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
30844 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
30845 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
30847 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
30848 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
30849 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
30850 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
30851 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
30853 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
30854 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
30855 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
30856 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
30857 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
30858 32K characters are checked.
30860 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
30861 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
30862 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
30863 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
30864 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
30866 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
30867 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
30869 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
30870 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
30871 matching regular expression.
30873 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
30879 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
30880 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
30881 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
30882 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
30883 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
30884 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
30885 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
30886 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
30887 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
30888 use the &%demime%& condition.
30890 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
30891 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
30892 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
30893 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
30894 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
30895 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
30897 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
30898 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
30901 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
30902 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
30904 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
30905 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
30906 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
30907 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
30909 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
30910 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
30911 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
30913 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
30916 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
30917 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
30918 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
30919 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
30920 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
30921 zero, no error occurred.
30923 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
30924 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
30925 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
30926 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
30930 .vitem &$found_extension$&
30931 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
30932 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
30933 extension it found.
30936 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
30937 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
30939 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
30940 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
30941 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
30944 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
30945 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
30947 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
30949 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
30950 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
30951 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
30952 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
30954 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
30955 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
30956 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
30965 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30966 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30968 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
30969 "Local scan function"
30970 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
30971 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
30972 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
30973 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
30974 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
30976 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
30977 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
30978 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
30979 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
30980 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
30982 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
30983 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
30984 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
30985 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
30987 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
30988 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
30989 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
30990 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
30992 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
30993 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
30994 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
30995 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
30996 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
30997 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
30998 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
30999 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
31000 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
31004 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
31005 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
31006 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
31007 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
31008 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
31009 directory, so you might set
31011 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
31013 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
31014 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
31015 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
31016 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
31017 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
31018 _src/local_scan.c_.
31020 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
31021 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
31023 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31025 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
31030 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
31031 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
31032 You must include this line near the start of your code:
31034 #include "local_scan.h"
31036 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
31037 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
31038 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
31039 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
31040 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
31041 strings and pointers to character strings:
31043 #define CS (char *)
31044 #define CCS (const char *)
31045 #define CSS (char **)
31046 #define US (unsigned char *)
31047 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
31048 #define USS (unsigned char **)
31050 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
31052 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
31054 The arguments are as follows:
31057 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
31058 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
31059 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
31061 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
31062 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
31063 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
31064 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
31065 case this changes in some future version.
31067 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
31068 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
31071 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
31074 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
31075 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
31076 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
31077 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
31078 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
31079 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
31081 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
31082 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31083 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
31085 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
31086 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31087 queued without immediate delivery.
31089 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
31090 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
31091 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
31092 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
31093 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
31096 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
31097 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
31098 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
31101 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31102 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
31103 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
31104 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
31105 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
31106 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
31107 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31109 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31110 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
31111 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31114 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
31115 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
31116 &%-oe%& command line options.
31120 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
31121 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
31122 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
31123 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
31124 want to do this, you must have the line
31126 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31128 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
31129 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
31130 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
31133 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
31134 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
31135 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
31136 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
31137 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
31138 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
31140 static int my_integer_option = 42;
31141 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
31143 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
31144 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
31145 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
31148 int local_scan_options_count =
31149 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
31151 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
31152 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
31156 my_string = some string of text...
31158 The available types of option data are as follows:
31161 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
31162 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
31163 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
31164 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
31165 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
31166 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
31169 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
31170 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
31171 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
31172 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
31175 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
31176 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
31179 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
31180 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
31181 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
31182 printed with the suffix K or M.
31184 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
31185 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
31186 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
31187 always output in octal.
31189 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
31190 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
31191 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
31193 .vitem &*opt_time*&
31194 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
31195 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
31198 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
31199 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
31203 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
31204 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
31205 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
31206 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
31207 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
31208 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
31209 C variables are as follows:
31212 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
31213 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
31215 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
31216 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
31218 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
31219 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
31220 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
31221 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
31224 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
31225 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
31226 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
31229 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
31230 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
31234 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
31235 selected, you should use code like this:
31237 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
31238 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
31240 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
31241 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
31242 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
31244 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
31245 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
31248 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
31249 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
31251 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
31252 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
31254 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
31255 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
31256 &%-bh%& command line option.
31258 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
31259 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
31260 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
31262 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
31263 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
31264 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
31265 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
31267 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
31268 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
31269 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
31271 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
31272 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
31274 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
31275 The number of accepted recipients.
31277 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
31278 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
31279 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
31280 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
31281 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
31282 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
31283 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
31284 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
31285 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
31286 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
31287 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
31288 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
31290 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
31291 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
31293 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
31294 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
31295 locally-submitted messages.
31297 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
31298 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
31299 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
31301 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
31302 The name of the sending host, if known.
31304 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
31305 The port on the sending host.
31307 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
31308 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
31310 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
31311 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
31313 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
31314 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
31315 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
31319 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
31320 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
31321 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
31322 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
31327 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
31328 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
31330 .vitem &*int&~type*&
31331 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
31332 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
31333 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
31334 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
31335 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
31336 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
31338 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
31339 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
31342 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
31343 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
31344 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
31349 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
31350 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
31353 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
31354 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
31356 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
31357 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
31358 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
31359 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
31361 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
31362 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
31363 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
31364 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
31365 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
31366 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
31367 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
31368 is NULL for all recipients.
31373 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
31374 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
31375 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
31376 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
31380 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
31381 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
31383 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
31384 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
31385 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
31386 for the process in &%newumask%&.
31388 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
31389 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
31390 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
31391 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
31392 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
31394 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
31396 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
31397 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
31398 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
31399 return value is as follows:
31404 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
31410 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
31416 The process timed out.
31420 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
31423 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
31424 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
31425 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
31426 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
31427 forks a subprocess that is running
31429 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
31431 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
31432 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
31433 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
31434 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
31436 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
31437 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
31438 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
31439 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
31442 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
31443 *sender_authentication)*&
31444 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
31447 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
31449 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
31452 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
31453 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
31454 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
31455 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
31456 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
31458 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
31459 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
31462 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
31463 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
31464 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
31465 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
31466 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
31467 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
31468 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
31469 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
31471 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
31472 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
31473 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
31474 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
31475 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
31476 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
31478 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
31479 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
31480 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
31481 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
31483 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
31484 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
31485 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
31486 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
31487 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
31488 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
31489 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
31490 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
31491 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
31492 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
31494 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
31495 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
31497 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
31498 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
31501 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
31502 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
31503 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
31504 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
31505 match the specification, the function does nothing.
31508 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
31509 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
31510 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
31511 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
31512 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
31513 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
31515 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
31517 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
31518 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
31519 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
31520 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
31521 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
31524 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
31525 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
31526 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
31527 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
31528 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
31529 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
31530 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
31531 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
31533 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
31534 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
31535 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
31537 &`OK `& match succeeded
31538 &`FAIL `& match failed
31539 &`DEFER `& match deferred
31541 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
31542 inability to contact a database.
31544 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
31546 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
31547 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
31548 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
31550 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
31552 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
31553 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
31554 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
31556 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
31558 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
31561 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
31563 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
31564 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
31565 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
31566 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
31567 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
31568 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
31571 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
31573 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
31574 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
31575 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
31576 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
31577 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
31578 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
31581 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
31582 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
31583 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
31584 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
31586 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
31587 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
31588 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
31589 value afterwards. For example:
31591 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
31592 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
31593 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
31596 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
31597 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
31598 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
31599 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
31606 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
31607 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
31608 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
31609 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
31610 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
31611 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
31612 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
31613 binary string is returned with an error message.
31615 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
31616 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
31617 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
31619 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
31620 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
31621 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
31622 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
31623 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
31625 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
31626 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
31627 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
31629 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
31630 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
31631 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
31632 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
31636 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
31637 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
31640 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
31641 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
31642 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
31643 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
31644 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
31645 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
31646 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
31647 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
31650 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
31651 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
31653 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
31654 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
31655 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
31656 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
31657 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
31658 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
31659 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
31661 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
31662 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
31664 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
31665 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
31666 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
31667 multiple output lines.
31669 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
31670 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
31671 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
31672 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
31673 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
31674 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
31675 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
31678 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
31679 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
31680 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
31681 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
31683 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
31684 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
31685 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
31687 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
31690 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
31693 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
31694 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
31695 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
31696 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
31697 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
31698 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
31704 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
31705 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
31706 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
31707 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
31708 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
31709 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
31710 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
31713 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
31714 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
31715 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
31716 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
31718 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
31719 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
31721 store_pool = POOL_PERM
31723 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
31724 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
31725 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
31726 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
31728 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
31729 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
31730 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
31731 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
31738 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31741 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
31742 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
31743 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
31744 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
31745 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
31746 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
31747 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
31748 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
31750 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
31751 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
31752 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
31753 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
31754 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
31756 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
31757 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
31758 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
31759 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
31760 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
31761 prevent it happening on retries.
31763 .vindex "&$domain$&"
31764 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31765 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
31766 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
31767 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
31768 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
31769 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
31770 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
31773 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
31774 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
31775 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
31776 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
31777 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
31778 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
31779 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
31781 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
31782 system_filter_user = exim
31784 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
31785 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
31786 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
31787 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
31788 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
31789 by the &%reply%& command.
31792 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
31793 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
31794 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
31795 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
31797 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
31798 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
31802 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
31803 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
31804 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
31805 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
31806 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
31807 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
31810 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
31811 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
31812 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
31813 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
31814 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
31815 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
31816 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
31818 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
31819 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
31820 succeed, it will not be tried again.
31821 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
31822 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
31824 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
31825 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
31826 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
31827 to which users' filter files can refer.
31831 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
31832 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
31833 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
31834 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
31835 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
31839 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
31840 .cindex "freezing messages"
31841 .cindex "message" "freezing"
31842 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
31843 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
31844 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
31845 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
31846 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
31847 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
31848 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
31849 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
31850 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
31852 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
31854 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
31856 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
31857 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
31858 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
31859 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
31860 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
31863 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
31864 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
31865 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
31866 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
31868 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
31869 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
31870 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
31871 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
31872 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
31873 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
31874 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
31875 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
31876 message. For example:
31878 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
31879 because it contains attachments that we are \
31880 not prepared to receive."
31883 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
31884 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
31885 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
31886 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
31887 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
31888 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
31891 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
31892 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
31894 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
31895 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
31896 generated by the filter.
31898 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
31900 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
31901 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
31907 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
31908 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
31913 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
31914 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
31915 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
31916 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
31917 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
31919 headers add <string>
31920 headers remove <string>
31922 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
31923 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
31924 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
31925 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
31926 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
31928 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
31929 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
31930 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
31933 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
31934 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
31937 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
31938 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
31939 space after input continuations is ignored.
31941 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
31942 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
31943 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
31944 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
31945 header with the same name, they are all removed.
31947 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
31948 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
31949 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
31950 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
31951 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
31952 used for all recipients of the message.
31954 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
31955 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
31956 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
31957 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
31958 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
31959 until the message is actually being written (see section
31960 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
31962 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
31963 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
31964 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
31965 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
31966 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
31967 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
31968 modified more than once.
31970 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
31971 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
31974 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
31975 headers remove "Subject"
31976 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
31977 headers remove "Old-Subject"
31982 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
31983 .cindex "envelope sender"
31984 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
31986 errors_to <some address>
31988 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
31989 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
31990 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
31993 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
31995 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
31996 address if its delivery failed.
32000 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
32001 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32002 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32003 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
32004 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
32005 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
32006 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
32007 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
32008 which implements such a filter:
32013 domains = +local_domains
32014 file = /central/filters/$local_part
32019 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
32020 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
32021 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
32022 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
32024 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
32025 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
32026 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
32027 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
32029 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
32030 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
32031 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
32038 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32039 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32041 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
32042 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
32043 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
32044 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
32045 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
32046 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
32047 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
32048 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
32050 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
32051 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
32052 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
32053 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
32054 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
32056 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
32057 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
32058 loopback interface specially in any way.
32060 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
32061 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
32066 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
32067 .cindex "message" "submission"
32068 .cindex "submission mode"
32069 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
32070 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
32071 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
32072 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
32074 control = submission
32076 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
32077 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
32078 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
32079 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
32080 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
32081 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
32083 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
32084 control = submission
32086 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
32087 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
32088 is used to separate options. For example:
32090 control = submission/sender_retain
32092 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
32093 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
32094 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
32095 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
32096 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
32097 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
32098 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
32100 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
32101 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
32104 control = submission/domain=some.domain
32106 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
32107 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
32108 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
32109 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
32111 accept authenticated = *
32112 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
32113 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
32114 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
32116 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
32117 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
32118 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
32120 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
32122 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
32125 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
32127 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
32128 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
32129 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
32130 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
32132 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
32133 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
32134 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
32135 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
32136 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
32137 spoof another's address.
32139 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
32140 .cindex "line endings"
32141 .cindex "carriage return"
32143 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
32144 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
32145 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
32146 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
32147 use CRLF or just CR.
32149 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
32150 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
32151 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
32152 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
32153 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
32154 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
32155 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
32156 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
32160 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
32162 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
32165 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
32166 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
32169 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
32170 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
32171 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
32172 people trying to play silly games.
32174 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
32175 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
32183 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
32184 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
32185 .cindex "address" "qualification"
32186 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
32187 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
32188 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
32189 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
32190 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
32192 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
32193 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
32194 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
32195 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
32196 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
32198 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
32199 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
32200 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
32201 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
32202 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
32203 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
32204 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
32205 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
32210 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
32211 .cindex "&""From""& line"
32212 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
32213 .cindex "sender" "address"
32214 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
32215 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
32216 .cindex "envelope sender"
32217 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32218 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
32219 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
32220 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
32222 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
32223 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
32225 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
32226 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
32227 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
32228 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
32229 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
32230 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
32231 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
32232 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
32233 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
32235 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
32236 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
32237 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
32238 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
32239 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
32240 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
32241 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
32243 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
32244 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
32245 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
32247 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
32248 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
32249 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
32250 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
32254 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
32255 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
32256 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
32257 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
32258 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
32259 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
32260 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
32263 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
32264 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
32267 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
32268 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
32272 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
32273 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
32275 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
32276 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
32277 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
32279 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
32282 For a locally-submitted message,
32283 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
32284 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
32285 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
32286 included in log lines in this case.
32288 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
32289 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
32295 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
32296 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
32297 includes the header line:
32299 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
32302 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
32303 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
32304 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
32305 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
32306 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
32307 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
32310 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
32311 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
32312 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
32313 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
32314 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
32316 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
32317 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
32318 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
32319 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
32320 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
32321 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
32322 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
32323 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
32327 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
32328 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
32329 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
32330 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
32331 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
32332 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
32333 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
32334 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
32338 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
32339 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
32340 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32341 .cindex "message" "submission"
32342 .cindex "submission mode"
32343 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
32344 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
32347 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
32348 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
32350 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
32351 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
32353 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32354 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
32355 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
32357 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
32358 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
32360 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
32361 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
32365 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
32367 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
32368 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
32369 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
32370 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
32371 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
32372 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
32373 &%qualify_domain%&.
32375 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
32376 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
32377 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
32378 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
32381 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
32382 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
32383 .cindex "message" "submission"
32384 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
32385 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
32386 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
32387 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
32388 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
32389 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
32390 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
32391 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
32392 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
32393 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
32396 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
32397 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
32398 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
32399 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
32400 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
32402 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
32403 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
32404 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
32405 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
32407 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
32408 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
32409 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
32412 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
32413 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
32414 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
32415 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
32416 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
32417 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
32418 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
32419 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
32420 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
32421 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
32422 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
32426 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
32427 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
32428 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
32429 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
32430 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
32431 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
32432 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
32433 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
32437 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
32438 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
32439 .cindex "message" "submission"
32440 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
32441 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
32442 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
32443 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
32446 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
32447 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
32448 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
32449 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
32450 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
32451 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
32452 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
32453 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
32454 line is added to the message.
32456 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
32457 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
32458 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
32459 options true at the same time.
32461 .cindex "submission mode"
32462 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
32463 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
32464 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
32465 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
32467 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
32468 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
32469 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
32470 created as follows:
32473 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32474 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
32475 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
32477 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
32478 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
32480 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
32481 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
32484 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
32485 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
32486 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
32487 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
32489 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
32490 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
32491 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
32492 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
32496 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
32497 "SECTheadersaddrem"
32498 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
32499 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
32500 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
32501 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
32502 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
32503 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
32504 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
32506 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
32507 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
32508 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
32509 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
32510 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
32511 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
32513 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
32514 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
32515 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
32517 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
32518 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
32519 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
32521 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
32522 X-added-second: another added header line
32524 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
32526 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
32527 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
32528 Each header-line is separately expanded.
32530 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
32531 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
32532 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
32533 not part of the names. For example:
32535 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
32538 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
32539 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
32540 Each item is separately expanded.
32541 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
32542 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
32543 will act as list separators.
32545 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
32546 items are expanded at routing time,
32547 and then associated with all addresses that are
32548 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
32549 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
32550 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
32552 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
32553 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
32554 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
32555 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
32557 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
32558 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
32559 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
32562 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
32563 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
32564 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
32565 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
32566 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
32567 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
32568 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
32570 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
32571 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
32572 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
32573 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
32575 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
32576 the following consequences:
32579 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
32580 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
32581 to it, at all times.
32583 Header lines that are added by a router's
32584 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
32585 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
32587 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
32588 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
32590 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
32591 a later router or by a transport.
32593 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
32594 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
32596 headers_remove = subject
32597 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
32601 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
32602 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
32608 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
32609 .cindex "address" "constructed"
32610 .cindex "constructed address"
32611 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
32614 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
32618 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
32620 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
32621 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
32622 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
32623 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
32624 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
32625 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
32626 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
32627 there is no password file entry.
32630 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
32631 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
32632 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
32633 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
32634 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
32635 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
32636 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
32637 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
32641 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
32642 .cindex "case of local parts"
32643 .cindex "local part" "case of"
32644 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
32645 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
32646 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
32647 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
32648 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
32649 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
32652 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
32653 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
32654 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
32655 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
32656 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
32660 domains = +local_domains
32661 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
32662 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
32665 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
32666 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
32667 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
32668 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
32669 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
32673 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
32674 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
32675 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
32676 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
32677 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
32678 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
32679 empty components for compatibility.
32683 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
32684 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
32685 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
32686 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
32687 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
32688 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
32690 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
32691 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
32692 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
32693 example, a header such as
32697 might get rewritten as
32699 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
32701 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
32702 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
32705 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
32706 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
32707 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
32708 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
32709 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
32710 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
32711 .ecindex IIDmesproc
32715 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32716 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32718 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
32719 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
32720 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
32721 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
32722 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
32723 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
32724 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
32727 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
32729 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
32731 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
32734 For mail delivery, the following are available:
32737 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
32739 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
32742 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
32745 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
32746 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
32749 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
32750 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
32751 used to contain the envelope information.
32755 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
32756 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
32757 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
32758 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
32759 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
32762 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
32763 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
32764 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
32765 processing is the same in both cases.
32767 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
32768 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
32769 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
32770 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
32771 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
32772 .cindex "transport" "filter"
32773 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
32774 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
32777 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
32778 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
32779 required for the transaction.
32781 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
32782 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
32783 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
32784 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
32785 is called for verification.
32787 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
32788 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
32789 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
32791 .cindex "carriage return"
32793 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
32794 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
32795 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
32798 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
32799 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
32800 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
32801 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
32802 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
32803 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
32804 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
32805 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
32806 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
32808 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
32809 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
32810 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
32811 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
32813 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
32814 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
32815 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
32816 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
32818 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
32819 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
32820 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
32821 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
32822 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
32823 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
32824 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
32825 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
32826 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
32827 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
32829 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
32830 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
32832 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
32833 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
32834 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
32835 square bracket of the IP address.
32840 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
32841 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
32842 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
32843 .cindex "host" "error"
32844 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
32845 message errors, and recipient errors.
32848 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
32849 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
32850 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
32853 Connection refused or timed out,
32855 Any error response code on connection,
32857 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
32859 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
32861 I/O errors at any time,
32863 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
32864 the &"."& at the end of the data.
32867 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
32868 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
32869 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
32870 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
32871 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
32872 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
32873 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
32874 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
32876 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
32877 .cindex "message" "error"
32878 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
32879 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
32880 message errors are:
32883 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
32886 Timeout after MAIL,
32888 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
32889 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
32890 connection at any other time.
32893 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
32894 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
32895 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
32896 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
32897 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
32898 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
32899 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
32900 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
32901 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
32902 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
32904 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
32905 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
32906 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
32909 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
32910 .cindex "recipient" "error"
32911 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
32912 recipient errors are:
32915 Any error response to RCPT,
32917 Timeout after RCPT.
32920 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
32921 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
32922 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
32923 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
32924 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
32925 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
32926 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
32927 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
32928 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
32929 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
32930 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
32931 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
32932 the retry clock is reset.
32934 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
32935 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
32936 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
32937 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
32938 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
32939 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
32940 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
32941 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
32942 recipient's retry time.
32945 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
32946 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
32947 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
32948 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
32949 until the next delivery attempt.
32951 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
32952 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
32953 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
32954 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
32955 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
32958 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
32959 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
32960 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
32961 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
32962 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
32963 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
32964 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
32966 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
32967 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
32968 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
32969 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
32970 then to be treated as a host error.
32972 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
32973 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
32974 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
32975 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
32976 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
32981 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
32982 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
32983 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
32986 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
32987 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
32988 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
32990 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
32992 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
32993 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
32994 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
32995 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
32996 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
32997 stream and exits with an error code.
32999 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
33000 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
33001 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
33002 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
33004 .cindex "carriage return"
33006 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33007 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
33008 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33010 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
33011 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
33012 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
33014 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
33015 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
33016 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
33017 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
33018 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
33019 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
33020 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
33021 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
33023 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33024 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
33025 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
33026 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
33027 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
33028 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
33029 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
33030 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
33031 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
33033 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
33034 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
33035 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
33037 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
33038 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
33039 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
33040 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
33041 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
33043 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
33044 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
33045 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
33046 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
33047 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
33048 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
33049 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
33051 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
33052 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
33053 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
33054 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
33055 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
33057 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
33058 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
33059 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
33060 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
33061 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
33062 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
33063 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
33064 a delivery process.
33066 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
33067 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
33068 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
33069 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
33070 however, available with &'inetd'&.
33072 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
33073 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
33074 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
33075 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
33077 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
33078 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
33079 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
33083 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
33084 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
33085 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
33086 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
33087 the error response to the last command. The default value for
33088 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
33089 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
33090 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
33093 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
33094 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
33095 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
33096 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
33097 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
33098 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
33099 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
33100 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
33101 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
33102 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
33103 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
33107 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
33108 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
33109 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
33110 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
33111 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
33112 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
33113 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
33114 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
33116 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
33117 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
33118 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
33119 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
33120 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
33123 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
33124 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
33125 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
33127 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
33128 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
33129 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
33130 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
33131 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
33136 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
33137 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
33138 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
33139 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
33140 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33142 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
33143 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
33144 called with the &%-bv%& option.
33146 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
33147 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
33148 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
33149 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
33150 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
33151 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
33152 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
33157 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
33158 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
33159 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
33160 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
33161 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
33162 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
33163 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33165 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
33166 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
33167 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
33168 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
33169 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
33170 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
33171 argument. For example,
33179 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
33180 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
33181 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
33182 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
33183 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
33185 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
33186 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
33187 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
33188 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
33189 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
33190 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
33191 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
33192 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
33194 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
33195 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
33196 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
33197 whatever the form of its argument. For
33200 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
33201 $sender_host_address
33203 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33204 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
33205 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
33206 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
33207 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
33208 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
33209 for it to change them before running the command.
33213 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
33214 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
33215 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
33216 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
33217 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
33218 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
33219 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
33220 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
33221 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
33222 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
33223 runs for RCPT commands:
33227 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
33231 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
33232 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
33233 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
33234 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
33235 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
33236 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
33237 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
33238 envelope along with the message.
33240 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
33241 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
33242 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
33243 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
33244 can be used to specify it.
33246 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
33247 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
33248 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
33249 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
33250 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
33253 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
33254 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
33255 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
33260 driver = manualroute
33261 transport = smtp_appendfile
33262 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
33266 driver = appendfile
33267 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
33272 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
33273 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
33274 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
33278 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
33279 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
33280 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
33281 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
33282 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
33283 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
33284 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
33285 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
33286 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
33287 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
33289 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
33290 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
33292 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
33293 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
33294 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
33295 make some use of automatically, for example:
33297 554 Unexpected end of file
33298 Transaction started in line 10
33299 Error detected in line 14
33301 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
33304 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
33305 The error message was:
33307 501 '>' missing at end of address
33309 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
33310 The error was detected in line 12.
33311 The SMTP command at fault was:
33313 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
33315 1 previous message was successfully processed.
33316 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
33318 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
33319 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
33321 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
33322 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
33326 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33327 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33329 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
33330 "Customizing messages"
33331 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
33332 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
33333 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
33334 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
33335 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
33337 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
33338 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
33339 option. Exim also adds the line
33341 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
33343 to all warning and bounce messages,
33346 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
33347 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
33348 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
33349 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
33350 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
33351 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
33352 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
33354 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
33355 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
33356 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
33357 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
33358 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
33361 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
33362 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
33363 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
33364 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
33365 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
33366 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
33367 option, rounded to a whole number.
33369 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
33372 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
33373 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
33375 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
33376 failing addresses with their error messages.
33378 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
33379 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
33381 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
33382 as part of the error report.
33384 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
33385 truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
33387 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
33390 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
33391 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
33392 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
33394 Subject: Mail delivery failed
33395 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
33396 {: returning message to sender}}
33398 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
33400 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
33401 {that you sent }{sent by
33405 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
33406 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
33408 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
33410 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
33413 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
33415 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
33418 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
33419 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
33420 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
33421 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
33422 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
33426 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
33427 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
33429 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
33430 the delayed addresses.
33432 The third item then ends the message.
33435 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
33436 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
33438 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
33439 $warn_message_delay
33441 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
33443 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
33444 {that you sent }{sent by
33448 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
33449 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
33451 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
33452 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
33453 The date of the message is: $h_date
33455 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
33457 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
33458 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
33459 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
33460 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
33461 the message will be returned to you.
33463 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
33464 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
33465 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
33466 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
33467 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
33468 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
33469 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
33470 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
33476 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33477 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33479 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
33480 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
33481 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
33485 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
33486 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
33487 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
33488 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
33489 routing explicitly:
33491 send_to_smart_host:
33492 driver = manualroute
33493 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
33494 transport = remote_smtp
33496 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
33497 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
33498 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
33499 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
33500 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
33505 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
33506 .cindex "mailing lists"
33507 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
33508 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
33509 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
33511 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
33512 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
33513 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
33514 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
33518 domains = lists.example
33519 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
33522 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
33525 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
33526 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
33527 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
33528 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
33530 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
33531 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
33534 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
33535 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
33536 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
33537 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
33538 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
33540 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
33541 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
33542 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
33543 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
33544 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
33545 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
33546 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
33547 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
33548 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
33552 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
33553 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
33554 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
33555 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
33556 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
33557 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
33558 addresses are not rigorously checked.
33560 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
33561 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
33562 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
33563 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
33564 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
33568 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
33569 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
33570 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
33571 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
33572 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
33573 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
33574 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
33575 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
33576 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
33577 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
33579 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
33580 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
33581 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
33582 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
33583 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
33584 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
33585 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
33586 pre-existing messages.
33588 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
33589 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
33590 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
33591 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
33592 one level of expansion anyway.
33596 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
33597 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
33598 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
33599 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
33600 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
33601 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
33603 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
33604 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
33608 domains = lists.example
33609 local_part_suffix = -request
33610 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
33615 domains = lists.example
33616 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
33617 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
33618 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
33621 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
33626 domains = lists.example
33628 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
33630 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
33631 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
33632 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
33635 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
33636 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
33637 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
33638 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
33639 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
33640 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
33641 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
33642 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
33643 &"unrouteable address"& error.
33645 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
33646 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
33647 the address, giving a suitable error message.
33652 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
33654 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
33655 .cindex "envelope sender"
33656 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
33657 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
33658 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
33659 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
33660 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
33661 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
33663 .oindex &%errors_to%&
33664 .oindex &%return_path%&
33665 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
33666 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
33667 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
33668 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
33669 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
33670 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
33671 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
33677 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
33678 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
33680 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
33681 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
33682 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
33683 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
33684 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
33685 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
33686 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
33689 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
33691 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33692 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
33693 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
33694 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
33695 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
33696 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
33698 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
33699 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
33700 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
33701 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
33705 domains = ! +local_domains
33707 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
33708 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
33711 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
33712 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
33713 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
33714 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
33717 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
33718 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
33719 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
33720 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
33721 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
33725 domains = ! +local_domains
33726 transport = remote_smtp
33728 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
33729 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
33732 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
33733 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
33734 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
33735 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
33738 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
33739 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
33740 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
33741 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
33742 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
33743 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
33751 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
33752 .cindex "virtual domains"
33753 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
33754 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
33758 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
33759 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
33760 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
33762 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
33763 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
33764 have login accounts on that host.
33767 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
33768 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
33769 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
33770 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
33771 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
33772 to a router of this form:
33776 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
33777 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
33780 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
33781 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
33782 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
33783 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
33784 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
33785 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
33787 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
33788 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
33789 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
33790 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
33792 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
33793 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
33794 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
33798 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
33799 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
33800 transport = my_mailboxes
33802 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
33803 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
33804 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
33805 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
33806 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
33810 driver = appendfile
33811 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
33814 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
33815 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
33817 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
33818 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
33819 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
33820 information about the domains.
33824 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
33825 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
33826 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
33827 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
33828 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
33829 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
33830 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
33831 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
33832 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
33833 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
33834 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
33835 example, consider this router:
33840 file = $home/.forward
33841 local_part_suffix = -*
33842 local_part_suffix_optional
33845 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
33846 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
33847 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
33848 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
33850 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
33851 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
33854 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
33855 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
33856 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
33857 control over which suffixes are valid.
33859 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
33860 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
33866 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
33867 local_part_suffix = -*
33868 local_part_suffix_optional
33871 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
33872 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
33873 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
33874 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
33875 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
33879 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
33880 .cindex "vacation processing"
33881 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
33882 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
33883 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
33884 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
33885 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
33888 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
33889 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
33890 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
33891 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
33893 spqr, vacation-spqr
33896 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
33897 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
33898 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
33899 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
33900 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
33904 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
33905 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
33909 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
33910 .cindex "message" "copying every"
33911 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
33912 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
33913 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
33914 each day's messages.
33916 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
33917 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
33918 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
33919 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
33923 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
33924 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
33925 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
33926 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
33927 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
33928 permanently connected.
33930 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
33931 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
33932 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
33935 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
33936 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
33937 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
33938 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
33939 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
33940 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
33941 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
33942 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
33944 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
33945 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
33946 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
33947 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
33948 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
33949 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
33952 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
33953 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
33954 intermittent host. For example:
33956 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
33958 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
33959 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
33960 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
33961 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
33962 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
33963 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
33966 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
33967 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
33968 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
33969 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
33970 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
33971 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
33972 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
33976 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
33977 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
33978 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
33979 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
33980 delivered immediately.
33982 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33983 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
33984 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
33985 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
33986 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
33987 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
33988 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
33989 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
33990 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
33991 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
33992 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
33993 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
33994 single SMTP connection.
33998 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33999 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34001 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
34002 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
34003 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
34004 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
34005 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
34006 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
34007 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
34008 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
34009 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
34010 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
34013 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
34014 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
34015 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
34016 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
34017 email is not desirable.
34019 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
34020 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
34021 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
34022 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
34023 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
34024 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
34025 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
34027 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
34028 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
34029 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
34030 before sending a message to the smart host.
34032 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
34033 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
34034 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
34036 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
34037 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
34038 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
34039 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
34040 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
34041 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
34042 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
34044 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
34048 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
34049 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
34051 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
34052 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
34053 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
34054 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
34055 successful, a zero return code is given.
34057 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
34058 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
34059 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
34060 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
34061 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
34064 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
34065 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
34066 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
34068 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
34069 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
34070 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
34071 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
34072 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
34074 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
34075 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
34076 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
34078 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
34079 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
34080 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
34081 are ever generated.
34083 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
34085 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
34086 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
34087 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
34090 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
34091 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
34092 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
34093 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
34094 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
34095 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
34100 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34101 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34103 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
34104 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
34105 .cindex "log" "types of"
34106 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
34111 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
34112 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
34113 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
34114 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
34115 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
34116 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
34117 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
34118 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
34120 .cindex "reject log"
34121 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
34122 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
34123 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
34124 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
34125 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
34126 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
34127 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
34128 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
34129 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
34132 .cindex "panic log"
34133 .cindex "system log"
34134 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
34135 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
34136 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
34137 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
34138 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
34139 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
34140 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
34141 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
34142 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
34145 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
34146 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
34147 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
34149 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
34152 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
34153 ways of changing this:
34156 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
34161 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
34163 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
34166 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
34170 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
34171 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34172 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
34173 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
34174 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
34175 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
34180 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
34181 .cindex "log" "destination"
34182 .cindex "log" "to file"
34183 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
34185 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
34186 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
34187 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
34188 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
34189 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
34190 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
34191 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
34193 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
34194 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
34195 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
34196 references to the host name:
34198 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
34200 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
34201 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
34202 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
34203 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
34204 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
34207 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
34208 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
34209 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
34210 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
34211 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
34212 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
34213 implying the use of a default path.
34215 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
34216 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
34217 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
34218 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
34219 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
34220 equivalent to the setting:
34222 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
34224 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
34227 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
34228 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
34230 Here are some examples of possible settings:
34232 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
34233 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
34234 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
34235 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
34237 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
34242 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
34243 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34244 .cindex "cycling logs"
34245 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34246 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
34247 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
34248 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
34249 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
34250 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
34251 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
34253 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
34254 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
34255 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
34256 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
34257 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
34258 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
34259 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
34260 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
34261 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
34262 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
34263 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
34268 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
34269 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
34270 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
34271 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
34272 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
34273 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
34274 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
34275 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
34277 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
34278 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
34279 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
34280 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
34282 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
34283 examples of names generated by the above examples:
34285 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
34286 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
34287 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
34288 /var/log/exim/main.200212
34290 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
34291 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
34292 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
34293 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
34295 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
34296 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
34297 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
34298 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
34299 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
34300 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
34303 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
34304 /var/log/exim-panic.log
34305 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
34306 /var/log/exim/panic
34310 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
34311 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
34312 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
34313 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
34314 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
34315 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
34316 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
34317 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
34318 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
34319 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
34320 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
34321 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
34322 the time and host name to each line.
34323 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
34326 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
34328 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
34330 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
34333 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
34334 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
34335 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
34336 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
34338 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
34339 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
34340 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
34341 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
34342 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
34343 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
34344 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
34345 RFC 3164, you should set
34347 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
34349 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
34350 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
34352 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
34353 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
34354 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
34355 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
34356 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
34357 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
34358 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
34359 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
34360 name, and pid as added by syslog:
34362 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
34363 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
34364 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
34365 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
34368 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
34371 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
34372 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
34373 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
34374 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
34376 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
34377 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
34378 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
34379 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
34380 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
34381 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
34383 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
34384 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
34385 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
34388 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
34390 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
34391 without modification.
34393 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
34394 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
34395 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
34400 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
34401 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
34402 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
34403 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
34404 timestamp. The flags are:
34406 &`<=`& message arrival
34407 &`=>`& normal message delivery
34408 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
34409 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
34410 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
34411 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
34412 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
34416 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
34417 .cindex "log" "reception line"
34418 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
34419 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
34420 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
34422 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
34423 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
34424 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
34426 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
34427 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
34428 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
34432 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
34436 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
34437 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
34438 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
34439 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
34440 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
34441 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
34442 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
34443 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
34444 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
34445 name in parentheses.
34447 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
34448 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
34449 the log containing text like these examples:
34451 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
34452 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
34454 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
34457 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
34458 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
34461 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
34462 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
34463 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
34464 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
34465 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
34466 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
34467 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
34468 suite that was used.
34470 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
34471 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
34472 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
34473 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
34474 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
34475 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
34476 authenticator name.
34478 .cindex "size" "of message"
34479 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
34480 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
34481 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
34482 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
34485 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
34486 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
34490 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
34491 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
34492 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
34493 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
34494 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
34495 to fit it on the page:
34497 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
34498 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
34499 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
34500 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
34501 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
34503 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
34504 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
34505 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
34506 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
34507 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
34509 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
34510 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
34511 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
34512 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
34514 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
34515 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
34517 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
34519 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
34520 parentheses afterwards.
34522 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
34523 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
34524 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
34525 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
34526 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
34527 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
34529 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
34530 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
34531 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
34532 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
34533 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
34535 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
34536 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
34538 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
34539 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
34542 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
34543 .cindex "discarded messages"
34544 .cindex "message" "discarded"
34545 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
34546 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
34547 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
34549 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
34550 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
34552 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
34553 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
34555 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
34556 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
34560 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
34561 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
34563 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
34564 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
34566 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
34567 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
34568 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
34570 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
34571 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
34573 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
34574 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
34575 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
34579 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
34580 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
34581 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
34582 following form is logged:
34584 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
34585 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
34587 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
34588 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
34590 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
34591 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
34592 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
34593 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
34594 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
34596 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
34597 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
34598 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
34599 flagged with &`**`&.
34603 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
34604 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
34605 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
34606 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
34607 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
34611 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
34614 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
34616 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
34617 at the end of its processing.
34622 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
34623 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
34624 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
34625 the following table:
34627 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
34628 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
34629 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
34630 &`CV `& certificate verification status
34631 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
34632 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
34633 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
34634 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
34635 &`H `& host name and IP address
34636 &`I `& local interface used
34637 &`id `& message id for incoming message
34638 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
34639 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
34640 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
34641 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
34642 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
34643 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
34644 &`S `& size of message
34645 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
34646 &`ST `& shadow transport name
34647 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
34648 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
34649 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
34650 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
34654 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
34655 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
34656 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
34659 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
34660 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
34661 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
34662 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
34663 during the first delivery attempt.
34665 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
34666 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
34667 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
34669 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
34670 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
34671 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
34672 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
34673 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
34676 .cindex "error" "ignored"
34677 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
34680 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
34681 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
34683 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
34684 failed. The delivery was discarded.
34686 A delivery set up by a router configured with
34687 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
34688 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
34692 failed. The delivery was discarded.
34700 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
34701 .cindex "log" "selectors"
34702 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
34703 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
34704 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
34707 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
34709 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
34710 selection marked by asterisks:
34712 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
34713 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
34714 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
34715 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
34716 &` arguments `& command line arguments
34717 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
34718 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
34719 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
34720 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
34721 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
34722 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
34723 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
34724 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
34725 &` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
34726 &` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
34727 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
34728 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
34729 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
34730 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
34731 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
34732 &` pid `& Exim process id
34733 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
34734 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
34735 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
34736 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
34737 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
34738 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
34739 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
34740 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
34741 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
34742 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
34743 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
34744 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
34745 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
34746 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
34747 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
34748 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
34749 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
34750 &` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
34751 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
34752 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
34753 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
34754 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
34756 &` all `& all of the above
34758 More details on each of these items follows:
34762 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
34763 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
34764 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
34765 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
34766 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
34767 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
34769 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
34770 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
34771 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
34772 this log selector is set.
34774 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
34775 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
34776 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
34777 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
34778 such users cannot access the log).
34780 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
34781 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
34782 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
34783 parentheses between them.
34785 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
34786 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
34787 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
34788 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
34789 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
34790 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
34791 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
34792 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
34793 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
34794 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
34795 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
34796 between the caller and Exim.
34798 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
34799 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
34800 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
34802 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
34803 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
34804 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
34805 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
34806 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
34807 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
34809 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
34810 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
34811 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
34813 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
34814 .cindex "size" "of message"
34815 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
34816 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
34818 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
34819 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
34820 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
34821 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
34822 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
34824 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
34825 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
34826 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
34827 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
34828 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
34829 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
34831 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
34832 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
34833 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
34834 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
34835 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
34837 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
34838 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
34839 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
34840 client's ident port times out.
34842 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
34843 .cindex "interface" "logging"
34844 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
34845 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
34846 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
34847 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
34850 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
34851 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
34852 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
34853 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
34854 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
34855 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
34856 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
34857 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
34858 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
34859 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
34860 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
34862 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
34863 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
34864 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
34866 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
34867 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
34868 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
34869 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
34870 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
34871 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
34872 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
34874 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
34875 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34876 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
34877 immediately after the time and date.
34879 .cindex "log" "queue run"
34880 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
34881 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
34883 .cindex "log" "queue time"
34884 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
34885 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
34886 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
34887 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
34888 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
34889 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
34890 message has been successfully received.
34892 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
34893 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
34894 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
34895 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
34897 .cindex "log" "recipients"
34898 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
34899 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
34900 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
34901 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
34903 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
34906 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
34907 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
34908 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
34909 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
34911 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
34912 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
34913 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
34914 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
34915 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
34917 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
34918 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
34919 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
34920 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
34923 .cindex "log" "return path"
34924 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
34925 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
34926 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
34927 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
34929 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
34930 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
34931 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
34932 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
34933 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
34935 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
34936 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
34937 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
34938 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
34941 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
34942 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
34945 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
34946 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
34947 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
34948 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
34950 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
34951 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
34953 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
34954 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
34955 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
34956 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
34957 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
34958 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
34961 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
34962 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
34963 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
34964 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
34965 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
34966 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
34967 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
34968 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
34969 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
34970 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
34972 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
34973 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
34974 reset if the daemon is restarted.
34975 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
34976 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
34977 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
34978 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
34979 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
34981 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
34982 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
34983 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
34984 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
34985 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
34986 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
34988 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
34989 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
34990 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
34991 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
34992 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
34993 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
34994 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
34995 already have their own log lines.
34997 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
34998 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
34999 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
35000 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
35001 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
35002 the same logging options.
35004 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
35005 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
35009 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
35010 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
35011 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
35012 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
35013 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
35015 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
35016 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
35017 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
35018 was accepted or used.
35020 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
35021 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
35022 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
35023 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
35024 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
35025 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
35026 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
35027 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
35029 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
35030 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
35031 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
35032 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
35033 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
35034 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
35035 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
35036 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
35037 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
35039 .cindex "log" "subject"
35040 .cindex "subject, logging"
35041 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
35042 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
35043 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
35044 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
35045 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
35047 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
35048 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
35049 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
35050 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
35052 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
35053 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
35054 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35055 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
35057 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
35058 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
35059 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35060 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
35061 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
35063 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
35064 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
35065 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
35066 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
35067 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
35069 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
35070 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
35071 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
35075 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
35076 .cindex "message" "log file for"
35077 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
35078 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
35079 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
35080 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
35081 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
35082 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
35083 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
35084 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
35085 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
35086 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
35087 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
35089 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
35090 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
35091 &%message_logs%& option false.
35097 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35098 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35100 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
35101 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
35102 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
35103 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
35104 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
35106 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
35107 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
35108 "list what Exim processes are doing"
35109 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
35110 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
35111 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
35112 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
35114 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
35115 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
35116 "extract statistics from the log"
35117 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
35118 "check address acceptance from given IP"
35119 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
35120 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
35121 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
35122 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
35123 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
35124 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
35127 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
35128 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
35129 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
35134 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
35135 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
35136 .cindex "process, querying"
35138 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
35139 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
35140 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
35141 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
35142 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
35143 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
35144 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
35145 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
35147 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
35148 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
35149 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
35152 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
35153 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
35154 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
35155 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
35156 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
35159 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
35160 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
35161 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
35162 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
35164 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
35166 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
35167 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
35168 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
35169 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
35170 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
35171 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
35173 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
35174 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
35178 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
35179 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
35180 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
35181 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
35185 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
35189 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
35190 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
35192 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
35193 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
35196 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
35197 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35198 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
35202 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
35203 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitve search. The field that is
35204 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
35206 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
35207 Match against the size field.
35209 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35210 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
35212 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35213 Match messages that are older than the given time.
35216 Match only frozen messages.
35219 Match only non-frozen messages.
35222 The following options control the format of the output:
35226 Display only the count of matching messages.
35229 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
35233 Display message ids only.
35236 Brief format &-- one line per message.
35239 Display messages in reverse order.
35242 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
35245 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
35249 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
35250 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
35251 .cindex "queue" "summary"
35252 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
35253 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
35254 running a command such as
35256 exim -bp | exiqsumm
35258 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
35259 it, as in the following example:
35261 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
35263 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
35264 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
35265 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
35266 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
35268 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
35269 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
35270 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
35271 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
35272 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
35273 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
35276 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
35277 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
35278 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
35279 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
35280 level"& addresses).
35285 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
35287 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
35288 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
35289 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
35290 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
35291 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
35292 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
35293 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
35294 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
35295 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
35296 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
35299 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
35302 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
35304 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
35305 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
35306 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
35308 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
35309 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
35310 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
35311 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
35312 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
35314 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
35315 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
35316 regular expression.
35318 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
35319 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
35322 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
35323 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
35327 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
35328 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
35329 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
35330 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
35331 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
35332 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
35336 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
35337 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
35338 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
35341 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
35342 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
35343 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
35344 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
35345 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
35346 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
35347 the &%--help%& option.
35350 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
35351 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
35352 .cindex "cycling logs"
35353 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
35354 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
35355 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
35356 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
35357 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
35358 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
35359 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
35361 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
35362 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
35364 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
35365 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
35366 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
35370 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
35371 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
35372 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
35373 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
35374 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
35375 logs are handled similarly.
35377 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
35378 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
35379 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
35380 any existing log files.
35382 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
35383 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
35384 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
35385 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
35386 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
35388 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
35390 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
35391 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
35395 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
35396 .cindex "statistics"
35397 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
35398 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
35399 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
35400 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
35401 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
35403 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
35404 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
35405 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
35406 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
35407 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
35409 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
35411 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
35412 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
35413 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
35414 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
35415 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
35416 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
35417 also produced per user.
35419 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
35420 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
35421 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
35422 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
35423 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
35425 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
35426 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
35427 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
35428 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
35429 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
35430 an entirely separate message.
35432 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
35433 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
35434 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
35435 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
35436 least one address that failed.
35438 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
35439 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
35440 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
35441 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
35442 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
35443 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
35444 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
35446 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
35447 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
35448 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
35450 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
35451 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
35452 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
35454 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
35457 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
35458 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
35459 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
35460 .cindex "checking access"
35461 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
35462 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
35463 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
35464 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
35465 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
35466 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
35468 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
35469 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
35471 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
35473 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
35474 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
35475 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
35476 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
35479 550 Relay not permitted
35481 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
35482 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
35483 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
35484 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
35487 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
35488 -f himself@there.example
35490 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
35491 mandatory arguments.
35493 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
35494 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
35495 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
35499 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
35500 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
35501 .cindex "building DBM files"
35502 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
35503 .cindex "lower casing"
35504 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
35505 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
35506 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
35507 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
35508 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
35509 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
35511 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
35512 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
35513 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
35514 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
35517 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
35518 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
35519 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
35523 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
35524 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
35525 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
35526 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
35528 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
35530 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
35531 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
35533 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
35534 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
35535 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
35536 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
35537 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
35538 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
35540 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
35541 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
35542 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
35543 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
35544 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
35545 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
35546 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
35552 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
35553 .cindex "retry" "times"
35554 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
35555 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
35556 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
35557 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
35558 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
35559 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
35560 output. For example:
35562 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
35563 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
35564 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
35565 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
35566 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
35567 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
35568 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
35569 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
35570 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
35571 past final cutoff time
35573 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
35574 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
35575 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
35576 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
35577 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
35578 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
35581 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
35582 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
35583 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
35584 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
35585 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
35586 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
35590 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
35591 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
35592 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
35593 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
35594 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
35595 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
35596 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
35599 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
35601 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
35604 &'callout'&: the callout cache
35606 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
35608 &'misc'&: other hints data
35611 The &'misc'& database is used for
35614 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
35616 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
35617 &(smtp)& transport)
35622 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
35623 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
35624 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
35625 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
35626 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
35628 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
35630 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
35632 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
35633 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
35635 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
35636 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
35637 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
35638 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
35639 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
35640 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
35641 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
35642 and a textual description of the error.
35644 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
35645 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
35646 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
35649 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
35650 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
35651 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
35652 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
35653 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
35654 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
35659 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
35660 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
35661 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
35662 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
35663 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
35664 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
35665 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
35666 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
35667 updated sufficiently often.
35669 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
35670 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
35671 the retry database:
35673 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
35675 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
35676 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
35677 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
35678 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
35679 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
35680 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
35681 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
35682 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
35683 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
35684 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
35685 whenever it removes information from the database.
35687 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
35688 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
35689 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
35690 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
35691 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
35693 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
35694 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
35695 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
35696 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
35697 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
35698 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
35699 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
35702 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
35703 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
35708 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
35709 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
35710 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
35711 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
35712 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
35713 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
35714 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
35717 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
35718 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
35719 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
35720 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
35721 by new data, for example:
35725 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
35726 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
35727 used as optional separators.
35732 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
35733 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
35734 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
35735 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
35736 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
35737 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
35738 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
35739 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
35740 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
35741 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
35742 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
35743 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
35744 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
35748 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
35751 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
35754 .vitem &%-interval%&
35755 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
35756 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
35758 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
35759 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
35762 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
35765 Suppress verification output.
35767 .vitem &%-retries%&
35768 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
35769 the lock (default 10).
35771 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
35772 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
35773 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
35774 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
35777 .vitem &%-timeout%&
35778 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
35779 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
35780 default), a non-blocking call is used.
35783 Generate verbose output.
35786 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
35787 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
35788 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
35789 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
35790 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
35791 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
35792 more than 30 minutes old.
35794 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
35795 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
35796 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
35797 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
35798 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
35799 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
35801 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
35802 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
35803 suppresses all output except error messages.
35807 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
35809 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
35811 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
35812 <&'some commands'&>
35815 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
35816 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
35819 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
35820 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
35822 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
35823 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
35827 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35828 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35830 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
35831 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
35832 .cindex "X-windows"
35833 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
35834 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
35835 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
35836 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
35837 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
35838 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
35839 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
35840 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
35844 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
35845 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
35846 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
35847 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
35848 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
35849 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
35850 parameters are for.
35852 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
35853 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
35854 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
35856 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
35858 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
35859 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
35860 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
35861 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
35862 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
35864 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
35865 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
35867 Eximon*background: gray94
35869 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
35870 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
35871 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
35872 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
35873 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
35874 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
35875 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
35878 Eximon*highlight: gray
35881 .cindex "admin user"
35882 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
35883 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
35885 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
35886 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
35887 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
35888 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
35889 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
35891 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
35892 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
35893 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
35894 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
35895 different parts of the display.
35900 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
35901 .cindex "stripchart"
35902 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
35903 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
35904 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
35905 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
35906 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
35907 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
35908 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
35909 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
35910 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
35912 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
35913 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
35914 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
35915 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
35917 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
35918 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
35919 to a single partition.
35921 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
35922 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
35923 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
35924 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
35925 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
35926 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
35927 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
35932 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
35933 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
35934 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
35935 .cindex "window size"
35936 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
35937 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
35938 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
35939 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
35940 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
35941 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
35943 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
35944 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
35945 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
35946 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
35948 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
35949 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
35950 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
35951 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
35952 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
35953 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35955 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
35956 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
35957 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35961 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
35962 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
35963 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
35964 the main log is maintained.
35965 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
35966 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
35967 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
35968 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
35969 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
35971 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
35972 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
35973 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
35974 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
35975 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
35976 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
35977 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
35978 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
35979 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
35980 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
35981 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35983 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
35984 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
35985 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
35986 It cannot go further back up the log.
35988 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
35989 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
35990 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
35991 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
35992 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
35993 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
35995 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
35996 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
35997 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
35998 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
35999 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
36000 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
36002 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
36003 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
36004 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
36005 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
36006 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
36007 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
36008 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
36009 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
36010 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
36015 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
36016 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
36017 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
36018 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
36019 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
36020 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
36021 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
36022 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
36023 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
36024 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
36026 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
36027 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
36028 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
36029 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
36030 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
36031 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
36032 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
36034 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
36035 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
36036 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
36037 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
36038 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
36039 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
36040 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
36042 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
36043 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
36044 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
36045 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
36047 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
36048 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
36049 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
36050 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
36051 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
36052 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
36053 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
36056 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
36057 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
36059 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
36060 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
36061 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
36062 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
36063 display is updated.
36067 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
36068 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
36069 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
36070 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
36071 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
36074 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
36075 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
36076 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
36077 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
36078 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
36080 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
36082 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
36086 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
36087 in a new text window.
36089 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
36090 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
36091 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
36093 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
36094 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
36095 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
36096 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
36098 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
36099 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
36100 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
36101 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
36102 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
36104 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
36105 that the message be frozen.
36107 .cindex "thawing messages"
36108 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
36109 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
36110 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
36111 that the message be thawed.
36113 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
36114 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
36115 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
36116 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
36118 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
36119 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
36122 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
36123 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36124 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36125 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36126 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
36127 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
36128 which case no action is taken.
36130 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
36131 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36132 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36133 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36134 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
36135 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
36136 case no action is taken.
36138 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
36139 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
36141 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
36142 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
36143 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
36144 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
36145 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
36146 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
36147 the address is qualified with that domain.
36150 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
36151 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
36152 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
36153 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
36154 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
36155 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
36156 if no output is generated.
36158 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
36159 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
36160 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
36161 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
36163 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
36164 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
36165 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
36172 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36173 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36175 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
36176 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
36177 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
36178 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
36180 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
36181 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
36182 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
36183 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
36184 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
36185 its security as compared with other MTAs.
36187 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
36188 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
36189 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
36190 as soon as possible.
36193 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
36194 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
36195 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
36196 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
36197 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
36198 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
36201 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
36202 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
36203 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
36204 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
36205 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
36206 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
36208 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
36209 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
36210 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
36211 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
36214 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
36215 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
36216 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
36217 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
36218 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
36219 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
36220 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
36221 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
36222 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
36226 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
36227 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
36228 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
36229 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
36230 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
36231 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
36232 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
36234 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
36237 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
36238 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
36239 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
36240 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
36241 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
36246 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
36248 .cindex "root privilege"
36249 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
36250 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
36251 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
36252 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
36253 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
36254 is required for two things:
36257 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
36258 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
36261 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
36262 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
36266 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
36267 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
36268 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
36269 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
36270 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
36271 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
36272 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
36273 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
36275 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
36276 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
36277 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
36279 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
36280 uid and gid in the following cases:
36285 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
36286 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
36287 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
36288 the calling process.
36289 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
36290 option may not be used at all.
36291 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
36292 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
36293 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
36298 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
36299 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
36302 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
36303 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
36304 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
36305 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
36306 testing address verification
36309 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
36312 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
36313 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
36316 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
36319 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
36320 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
36321 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
36322 will be used during message reception.
36324 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
36325 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
36327 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
36328 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
36329 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
36330 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
36331 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
36332 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
36333 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
36334 generating bounce and warning messages.
36336 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
36337 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
36338 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
36339 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
36341 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
36342 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
36348 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
36349 .cindex "privilege, running without"
36350 .cindex "unprivileged running"
36351 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
36352 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
36353 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
36354 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
36355 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
36356 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
36357 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
36361 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
36362 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
36363 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
36364 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
36366 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
36367 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
36368 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
36369 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
36370 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
36372 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
36373 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
36374 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
36377 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
36378 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
36379 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
36381 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
36382 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
36383 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
36384 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
36385 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
36386 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
36387 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
36388 address this problem at this time.
36390 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
36391 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
36392 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
36393 be used in the most straightforward way.
36395 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
36396 number of restrictions on what you can do:
36399 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
36400 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
36401 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
36402 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
36403 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
36405 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
36406 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
36408 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
36409 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
36410 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
36411 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
36413 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
36414 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
36417 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
36418 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
36419 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
36421 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
36422 owned by the Exim user.
36424 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
36425 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
36426 mailboxes need to be created manually.
36431 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
36432 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
36433 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
36434 gives more security at essentially no cost.
36436 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
36437 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
36442 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
36443 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
36444 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
36448 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
36449 .cindex "security" "local commands"
36450 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
36451 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
36452 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
36453 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
36454 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
36457 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
36458 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
36459 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
36460 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
36461 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
36463 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
36464 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
36465 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
36466 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
36467 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
36468 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
36469 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
36471 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
36472 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
36473 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
36475 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
36476 taint checking might apply to their usage.
36478 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analagous to shell's eval builtin and
36479 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
36480 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
36482 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
36483 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
36484 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
36486 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
36487 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
36488 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
36489 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
36495 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
36496 .cindex "security" "data sources"
36497 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
36498 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
36499 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
36500 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
36501 are some issues to be aware of:
36504 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
36506 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
36508 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
36509 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
36510 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
36511 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
36512 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
36513 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
36516 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
36517 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
36518 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
36520 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
36521 expected to yield one result.
36527 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
36528 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
36529 .cindex "IP source routing"
36530 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
36531 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
36532 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
36533 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
36537 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
36538 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
36539 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
36544 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
36545 .cindex "trusted users"
36546 .cindex "admin user"
36547 .cindex "privileged user"
36548 .cindex "user" "trusted"
36549 .cindex "user" "admin"
36550 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
36551 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
36552 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
36553 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
36554 permit a remote host to be specified.
36557 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
36558 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
36559 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
36560 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
36561 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
36562 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
36564 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
36565 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
36566 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
36567 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
36568 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
36570 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
36571 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
36572 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
36573 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
36574 includes the contents of files on the spool.
36578 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
36579 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
36580 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
36581 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
36582 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
36583 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
36585 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
36586 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
36587 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
36588 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
36589 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
36590 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
36595 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
36596 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
36597 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
36598 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
36599 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
36600 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
36604 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
36605 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
36606 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
36607 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
36608 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
36613 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
36614 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
36615 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
36616 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
36621 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
36622 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
36623 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
36624 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
36625 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
36629 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
36630 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
36631 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
36635 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
36636 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
36637 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
36638 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
36639 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
36640 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
36641 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
36643 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
36644 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
36649 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
36650 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
36651 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
36652 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
36656 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
36657 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
36658 enough to hold the result.
36659 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
36664 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36665 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36667 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
36668 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
36669 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
36670 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
36671 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
36672 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
36673 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
36674 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
36675 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
36676 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
36677 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
36678 themselves are recoverable.
36680 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
36681 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
36682 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
36685 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
36686 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
36687 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
36688 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
36689 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
36691 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
36692 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
36693 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
36694 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
36695 will always be the case.
36697 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
36699 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
36702 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
36704 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
36705 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
36706 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
36707 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
36708 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
36709 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
36710 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
36711 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
36714 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
36715 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
36716 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
36717 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
36718 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
36719 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
36720 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
36721 normally the Exim user.
36723 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
36724 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
36725 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
36726 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
36727 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
36728 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
36729 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
36730 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
36732 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
36733 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
36734 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
36735 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
36737 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
36738 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
36741 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36742 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
36743 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
36744 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
36745 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
36746 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
36747 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
36748 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
36749 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
36752 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36753 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
36754 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
36755 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
36756 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
36757 character. It may contain internal newlines.
36759 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36760 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
36761 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
36762 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
36763 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
36764 character. It may contain internal newlines.
36766 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
36767 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
36768 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
36770 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
36771 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
36772 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
36773 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
36774 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
36776 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
36777 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
36778 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
36779 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
36780 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
36782 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
36783 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
36784 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
36786 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
36787 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
36788 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
36790 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
36791 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
36794 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
36795 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
36796 present if the number is greater than zero.
36798 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
36799 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
36800 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
36802 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
36803 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
36804 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
36806 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
36807 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
36810 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
36811 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
36812 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
36815 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
36816 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
36817 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
36818 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
36820 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
36821 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
36822 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
36824 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
36825 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
36826 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
36827 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
36828 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
36829 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
36831 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
36832 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
36833 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
36834 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
36835 supplied by the remote host, if any.
36837 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
36838 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
36839 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
36840 generated messages.
36843 The message is from a local sender.
36845 .vitem &%-localerror%&
36846 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
36848 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
36849 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
36850 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
36851 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
36853 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
36854 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
36855 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
36858 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
36859 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
36862 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
36863 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
36864 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
36866 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
36867 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
36868 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
36870 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
36871 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
36872 of &$spam_score_int$&.
36874 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
36875 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
36876 certificate was verified by the server.
36878 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
36879 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
36880 name of the cipher suite that was used.
36882 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
36883 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
36884 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
36888 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
36889 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
36890 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
36891 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
36892 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
36893 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
36894 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
36895 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
36896 addresses are complete.
36898 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
36899 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
36900 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
36901 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
36902 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
36903 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
36905 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
36906 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
36907 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36909 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
36910 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
36911 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
36912 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
36916 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36917 darcy@austen.fict.example
36919 alice@wonderland.fict.example
36921 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
36922 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
36923 line is of the following form:
36925 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
36926 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
36928 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
36929 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
36930 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
36931 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
36932 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
36933 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
36934 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
36935 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
36938 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
36939 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
36940 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
36941 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
36942 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
36946 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
36947 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
36948 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
36949 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
36950 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
36951 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
36952 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
36953 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
36954 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
36955 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
36958 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
36959 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
36960 typical set of headers:
36962 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
36963 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
36964 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
36965 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
36966 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
36967 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
36968 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
36969 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36970 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
36971 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36972 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
36974 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
36975 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
36976 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
36977 .ecindex IIDforspo1
36978 .ecindex IIDforspo2
36979 .ecindex IIDforspo3
36981 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36982 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36984 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
36988 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
36989 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
36990 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
36991 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
36993 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
36994 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
36996 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
36998 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
36999 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
37000 (including transport filters)
37001 except cutthrough delivery.
37003 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
37004 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
37005 different signature contexts.
37008 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
37009 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
37010 Exim's standard controls.
37012 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
37013 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
37014 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
37015 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
37017 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
37018 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
37019 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
37020 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
37022 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
37023 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
37024 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
37025 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
37029 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
37030 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
37032 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
37033 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
37035 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
37037 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
37038 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
37040 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
37042 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
37043 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
37044 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
37045 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
37047 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
37049 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
37050 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
37051 The result can either
37053 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
37055 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
37058 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
37059 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
37063 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
37065 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
37066 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
37067 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
37068 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
37070 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
37072 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
37073 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
37074 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
37075 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
37078 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
37080 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
37081 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
37082 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
37086 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
37087 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
37089 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
37090 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
37091 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
37092 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
37093 If any ACL call does not acccept, the message is not accepted.
37094 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
37095 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
37097 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
37098 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
37099 runtime of the ACL.
37101 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
37102 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
37103 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
37104 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
37106 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
37107 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
37108 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
37109 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
37110 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
37111 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
37114 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
37116 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
37117 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
37118 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
37120 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
37122 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
37123 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
37124 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
37126 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
37129 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
37130 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
37133 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
37134 available (from most to least important):
37138 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
37139 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
37140 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
37141 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
37142 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
37143 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
37145 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
37146 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37148 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
37149 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37151 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
37152 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37154 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
37156 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
37157 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
37158 "fail" or "invalid". One of
37160 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
37161 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
37163 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
37164 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
37166 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
37167 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
37168 means that the message body was modified in transit.
37170 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
37171 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
37172 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
37173 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
37175 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
37176 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
37177 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
37178 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37179 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
37180 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
37181 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
37182 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37183 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
37184 The key record selector string.
37185 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
37186 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
37187 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
37188 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37189 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
37190 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37191 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
37192 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
37193 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
37194 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
37195 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
37196 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
37197 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
37198 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
37199 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
37200 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
37201 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
37202 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
37203 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
37204 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
37205 integer size comparisons against this value.
37206 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
37207 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
37208 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
37209 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
37210 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
37211 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
37212 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
37213 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37215 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
37216 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37218 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
37219 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
37222 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
37225 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
37226 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
37227 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
37228 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
37229 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
37232 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
37233 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
37234 sender_domains = gmail.com
37235 dkim_signers = gmail.com
37239 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
37240 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
37241 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
37242 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
37245 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
37246 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
37247 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
37248 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
37251 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
37252 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
37253 for more information of what they mean.
37256 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37257 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37259 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
37260 "Adding drivers or lookups"
37261 .cindex "adding drivers"
37262 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
37263 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
37264 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
37265 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
37268 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
37269 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
37271 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
37273 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
37275 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
37276 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
37277 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
37279 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
37281 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
37284 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
37285 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
37287 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
37288 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
37289 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
37290 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
37291 simple form that most lookups have.
37293 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
37294 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
37295 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
37297 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
37300 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
37301 as for other drivers and lookups.
37304 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
37305 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
37306 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
37307 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
37308 searched using a binary chop procedure.
37310 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
37311 the interface that is expected.
37316 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37317 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37319 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37320 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
37321 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
37322 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
37324 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37329 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
37330 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
37334 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
37335 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
37336 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
37339 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37340 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////